annotate man/files.texi @ 36491:532d458f0d2b

*** empty log message ***
author Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
date Fri, 02 Mar 2001 20:31:48 +0000
parents e06c9b1a0b04
children 4dff107cf2a1
Ignore whitespace changes - Everywhere: Within whitespace: At end of lines:
rev   line source
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1 @c This is part of the Emacs manual.
28123
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2 @c Copyright (C) 1985,86,87,93,94,95,97,99, 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3 @c See file emacs.texi for copying conditions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4 @node Files, Buffers, Fixit, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5 @chapter File Handling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6 @cindex files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
8 The operating system stores data permanently in named @dfn{files}. So
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
9 most of the text you edit with Emacs comes from a file and is ultimately
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
10 stored in a file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
11
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12 To edit a file, you must tell Emacs to read the file and prepare a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
13 buffer containing a copy of the file's text. This is called
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
14 @dfn{visiting} the file. Editing commands apply directly to text in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
15 buffer; that is, to the copy inside Emacs. Your changes appear in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
16 file itself only when you @dfn{save} the buffer back into the file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
17
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
18 In addition to visiting and saving files, Emacs can delete, copy,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
19 rename, and append to files, keep multiple versions of them, and operate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
20 on file directories.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
21
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
22 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
23 * File Names:: How to type and edit file-name arguments.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
24 * Visiting:: Visiting a file prepares Emacs to edit the file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
25 * Saving:: Saving makes your changes permanent.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
26 * Reverting:: Reverting cancels all the changes not saved.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
27 * Auto Save:: Auto Save periodically protects against loss of data.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
28 * File Aliases:: Handling multiple names for one file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
29 * Version Control:: Version control systems (RCS, CVS and SCCS).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
30 * Directories:: Creating, deleting, and listing file directories.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
31 * Comparing Files:: Finding where two files differ.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
32 * Misc File Ops:: Other things you can do on files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
33 * Compressed Files:: Accessing compressed files.
28123
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
34 * File Archives:: Operating on tar, zip, jar etc. archive files.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
35 * Remote Files:: Accessing files on other sites.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
36 * Quoted File Names:: Quoting special characters in file names.
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
37 * File Name Cache:: Completion against a list of files you often use.
28526
297e03ccd7e6 (Backup): backup-enable-predicate.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28327
diff changeset
38 * File Conveniences:: Convenience Features for Finding Files.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
39 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
40
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
41 @node File Names
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
42 @section File Names
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
43 @cindex file names
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
44
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
45 Most Emacs commands that operate on a file require you to specify the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
46 file name. (Saving and reverting are exceptions; the buffer knows which
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
47 file name to use for them.) You enter the file name using the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
48 minibuffer (@pxref{Minibuffer}). @dfn{Completion} is available, to make
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
49 it easier to specify long file names. @xref{Completion}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
50
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
51 For most operations, there is a @dfn{default file name} which is used
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
52 if you type just @key{RET} to enter an empty argument. Normally the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
53 default file name is the name of the file visited in the current buffer;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
54 this makes it easy to operate on that file with any of the Emacs file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
55 commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
56
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
57 @vindex default-directory
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
58 Each buffer has a default directory, normally the same as the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
59 directory of the file visited in that buffer. When you enter a file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
60 name without a directory, the default directory is used. If you specify
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
61 a directory in a relative fashion, with a name that does not start with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
62 a slash, it is interpreted with respect to the default directory. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
63 default directory is kept in the variable @code{default-directory},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
64 which has a separate value in every buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
65
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
66 For example, if the default file name is @file{/u/rms/gnu/gnu.tasks} then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
67 the default directory is @file{/u/rms/gnu/}. If you type just @samp{foo},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
68 which does not specify a directory, it is short for @file{/u/rms/gnu/foo}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
69 @samp{../.login} would stand for @file{/u/rms/.login}. @samp{new/foo}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
70 would stand for the file name @file{/u/rms/gnu/new/foo}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
71
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
72 @findex cd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
73 @findex pwd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
74 The command @kbd{M-x pwd} prints the current buffer's default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
75 directory, and the command @kbd{M-x cd} sets it (to a value read using
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
76 the minibuffer). A buffer's default directory changes only when the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
77 @code{cd} command is used. A file-visiting buffer's default directory
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
78 is initialized to the directory of the file that is visited there. If
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
79 you create a buffer with @kbd{C-x b}, its default directory is copied
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
80 from that of the buffer that was current at the time.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
81
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
82 @vindex insert-default-directory
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
83 The default directory actually appears in the minibuffer when the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
84 minibuffer becomes active to read a file name. This serves two
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
85 purposes: it @emph{shows} you what the default is, so that you can type
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
86 a relative file name and know with certainty what it will mean, and it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
87 allows you to @emph{edit} the default to specify a different directory.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
88 This insertion of the default directory is inhibited if the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
89 @code{insert-default-directory} is set to @code{nil}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
90
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
91 Note that it is legitimate to type an absolute file name after you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
92 enter the minibuffer, ignoring the presence of the default directory
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
93 name as part of the text. The final minibuffer contents may look
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
94 invalid, but that is not so. For example, if the minibuffer starts out
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
95 with @samp{/usr/tmp/} and you add @samp{/x1/rms/foo}, you get
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
96 @samp{/usr/tmp//x1/rms/foo}; but Emacs ignores everything through the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
97 first slash in the double slash; the result is @samp{/x1/rms/foo}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
98 @xref{Minibuffer File}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
99
36324
63c47fc9df21 (File Names): Add documentation of the tilde expansion in file names.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36323
diff changeset
100 @cindex environment variables in file names
63c47fc9df21 (File Names): Add documentation of the tilde expansion in file names.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36323
diff changeset
101 @cindex expansion of environment variables
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
102 @samp{$} in a file name is used to substitute environment variables.
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
103 For example, if you have used the shell command @command{export
29107
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28671
diff changeset
104 FOO=rms/hacks} to set up an environment variable named @env{FOO}, then
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
105 you can use @file{/u/$FOO/test.c} or @file{/u/$@{FOO@}/test.c} as an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
106 abbreviation for @file{/u/rms/hacks/test.c}. The environment variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
107 name consists of all the alphanumeric characters after the @samp{$};
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
108 alternatively, it may be enclosed in braces after the @samp{$}. Note
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
109 that shell commands to set environment variables affect Emacs only if
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
110 done before Emacs is started.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
111
36324
63c47fc9df21 (File Names): Add documentation of the tilde expansion in file names.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36323
diff changeset
112 @cindex home directory shorthand
63c47fc9df21 (File Names): Add documentation of the tilde expansion in file names.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36323
diff changeset
113 You can use the @file{~/} in a file name to mean your home directory,
63c47fc9df21 (File Names): Add documentation of the tilde expansion in file names.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36323
diff changeset
114 or @file{~@var{user-id}/} to mean the home directory of a user whose
36325
cf1b9eaadeaf (File Names): Add a note about ~/ peculiarities on DOS/Windows.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36324
diff changeset
115 login name is @code{user-id}. (On DOS and Windows systems, where a user
cf1b9eaadeaf (File Names): Add a note about ~/ peculiarities on DOS/Windows.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36324
diff changeset
116 doesn't have a home directory, Emacs substitutes @file{~/} with the
cf1b9eaadeaf (File Names): Add a note about ~/ peculiarities on DOS/Windows.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36324
diff changeset
117 value of the environment variable @code{HOME}; see @ref{General
cf1b9eaadeaf (File Names): Add a note about ~/ peculiarities on DOS/Windows.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36324
diff changeset
118 Variables}.)
36324
63c47fc9df21 (File Names): Add documentation of the tilde expansion in file names.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36323
diff changeset
119
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
120 To access a file with @samp{$} in its name, type @samp{$$}. This pair
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
121 is converted to a single @samp{$} at the same time as variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
122 substitution is performed for single @samp{$}. Alternatively, quote the
36324
63c47fc9df21 (File Names): Add documentation of the tilde expansion in file names.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36323
diff changeset
123 whole file name with @samp{/:} (@pxref{Quoted File Names}). File names
63c47fc9df21 (File Names): Add documentation of the tilde expansion in file names.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36323
diff changeset
124 which begin with a literal @samp{~} should also be quoted with @samp{/:}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
125
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
126 @findex substitute-in-file-name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
127 The Lisp function that performs the substitution is called
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
128 @code{substitute-in-file-name}. The substitution is performed only on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
129 file names read as such using the minibuffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
130
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
131 You can include non-ASCII characters in file names if you set the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
132 variable @code{file-name-coding-system} to a non-@code{nil} value.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
133 @xref{Specify Coding}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
134
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
135 @node Visiting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
136 @section Visiting Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
137 @cindex visiting files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
138
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
139 @c WideCommands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
140 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
141 @item C-x C-f
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
142 Visit a file (@code{find-file}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
143 @item C-x C-r
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
144 Visit a file for viewing, without allowing changes to it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
145 (@code{find-file-read-only}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
146 @item C-x C-v
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
147 Visit a different file instead of the one visited last
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
148 (@code{find-alternate-file}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
149 @item C-x 4 f
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
150 Visit a file, in another window (@code{find-file-other-window}). Don't
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
151 alter what is displayed in the selected window.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
152 @item C-x 5 f
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
153 Visit a file, in a new frame (@code{find-file-other-frame}). Don't
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
154 alter what is displayed in the selected frame.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
155 @item M-x find-file-literally
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
156 Visit a file with no conversion of the contents.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
157 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
158
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
159 @cindex files, visiting and saving
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
160 @cindex saving files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
161 @dfn{Visiting} a file means copying its contents into an Emacs buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
162 so you can edit them. Emacs makes a new buffer for each file that you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
163 visit. We say that this buffer is visiting the file that it was created
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
164 to hold. Emacs constructs the buffer name from the file name by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
165 throwing away the directory, keeping just the name proper. For example,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
166 a file named @file{/usr/rms/emacs.tex} would get a buffer named
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
167 @samp{emacs.tex}. If there is already a buffer with that name, a unique
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
168 name is constructed by appending @samp{<2>}, @samp{<3>}, or so on, using
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
169 the lowest number that makes a name that is not already in use.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
170
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
171 Each window's mode line shows the name of the buffer that is being displayed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
172 in that window, so you can always tell what buffer you are editing.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
173
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
174 The changes you make with editing commands are made in the Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
175 buffer. They do not take effect in the file that you visited, or any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
176 place permanent, until you @dfn{save} the buffer. Saving the buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
177 means that Emacs writes the current contents of the buffer into its
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
178 visited file. @xref{Saving}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
179
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
180 @cindex modified (buffer)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
181 If a buffer contains changes that have not been saved, we say the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
182 buffer is @dfn{modified}. This is important because it implies that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
183 some changes will be lost if the buffer is not saved. The mode line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
184 displays two stars near the left margin to indicate that the buffer is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
185 modified.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
186
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
187 @kindex C-x C-f
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
188 @findex find-file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
189 To visit a file, use the command @kbd{C-x C-f} (@code{find-file}). Follow
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
190 the command with the name of the file you wish to visit, terminated by a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
191 @key{RET}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
192
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
193 The file name is read using the minibuffer (@pxref{Minibuffer}), with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
194 defaulting and completion in the standard manner (@pxref{File Names}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
195 While in the minibuffer, you can abort @kbd{C-x C-f} by typing @kbd{C-g}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
196
35647
d1a5bb6d3811 (Visiting): Document the file selection dialog popped by C-x C-f.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35620
diff changeset
197 @cindex file selection dialog
d1a5bb6d3811 (Visiting): Document the file selection dialog popped by C-x C-f.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35620
diff changeset
198 When Emacs is built with a suitable GUI toolkit, it pops up the
d1a5bb6d3811 (Visiting): Document the file selection dialog popped by C-x C-f.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35620
diff changeset
199 standard File Selection dialog of that toolkit instead of prompting for
d1a5bb6d3811 (Visiting): Document the file selection dialog popped by C-x C-f.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35620
diff changeset
200 the file name in the minibuffer. On Unix and GNU/Linux platforms, Emacs
d1a5bb6d3811 (Visiting): Document the file selection dialog popped by C-x C-f.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35620
diff changeset
201 does that when built with LessTif and Motif toolkits; on MS-Windows, the
d1a5bb6d3811 (Visiting): Document the file selection dialog popped by C-x C-f.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35620
diff changeset
202 GUI version does that by default.
d1a5bb6d3811 (Visiting): Document the file selection dialog popped by C-x C-f.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35620
diff changeset
203
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
204 Your confirmation that @kbd{C-x C-f} has completed successfully is the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
205 appearance of new text on the screen and a new buffer name in the mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
206 line. If the specified file does not exist and could not be created, or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
207 cannot be read, then you get an error, with an error message displayed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
208 in the echo area.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
209
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
210 If you visit a file that is already in Emacs, @kbd{C-x C-f} does not make
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
211 another copy. It selects the existing buffer containing that file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
212 However, before doing so, it checks that the file itself has not changed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
213 since you visited or saved it last. If the file has changed, a warning
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
214 message is printed. @xref{Interlocking,,Simultaneous Editing}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
215
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
216 @cindex creating files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
217 What if you want to create a new file? Just visit it. Emacs prints
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
218 @samp{(New File)} in the echo area, but in other respects behaves as if
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
219 you had visited an existing empty file. If you make any changes and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
220 save them, the file is created.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
221
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
222 Emacs recognizes from the contents of a file which convention it uses
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
223 to separate lines---newline (used on GNU/Linux and on Unix),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
224 carriage-return linefeed (used on Microsoft systems), or just
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
225 carriage-return (used on the Macintosh)---and automatically converts the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
226 contents to the normal Emacs convention, which is that the newline
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
227 character separates lines. This is a part of the general feature of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
228 coding system conversion (@pxref{Coding Systems}), and makes it possible
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
229 to edit files imported from various different operating systems with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
230 equal convenience. If you change the text and save the file, Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
231 performs the inverse conversion, changing newlines back into
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
232 carriage-return linefeed or just carriage-return if appropriate.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
233
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
234 @vindex find-file-run-dired
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
235 If the file you specify is actually a directory, @kbd{C-x C-f} invokes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
236 Dired, the Emacs directory browser, so that you can ``edit'' the contents
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
237 of the directory (@pxref{Dired}). Dired is a convenient way to delete,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
238 look at, or operate on the files in the directory. However, if the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
239 variable @code{find-file-run-dired} is @code{nil}, then it is an error
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
240 to try to visit a directory.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
241
36326
70c08680c0bf (Visiting): Add a note about visiting file archives.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36325
diff changeset
242 Files which are actually collections of other files, or @dfn{file
70c08680c0bf (Visiting): Add a note about visiting file archives.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36325
diff changeset
243 archives}, are visited in special modes which invoke a Dired-like
70c08680c0bf (Visiting): Add a note about visiting file archives.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36325
diff changeset
244 environment to allow operations on archive members. @xref{File
70c08680c0bf (Visiting): Add a note about visiting file archives.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36325
diff changeset
245 Archives}, for more about these features.
70c08680c0bf (Visiting): Add a note about visiting file archives.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36325
diff changeset
246
28327
f7b17a6af3db (Visiting): List wildcard chars. Mention find-file-wildcards.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28123
diff changeset
247 @cindex wildcard characters in file names
f7b17a6af3db (Visiting): List wildcard chars. Mention find-file-wildcards.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28123
diff changeset
248 @vindex find-file-wildcards
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
249 If the file name you specify contains shell-style wildcard
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
250 characters, Emacs visits all the files that match it. Wildcards
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
251 comprise @samp{?}, @samp{*} and @samp{[@dots{}]} sequences.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
252 @xref{Quoted File Names}, for how to visit a file whose name actually
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
253 contains wildcard characters. You can disable the wildcard feature by
28327
f7b17a6af3db (Visiting): List wildcard chars. Mention find-file-wildcards.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28123
diff changeset
254 customizing @code{find-file-wildcards}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
255
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
256 If you visit a file that the operating system won't let you modify,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
257 Emacs makes the buffer read-only, so that you won't go ahead and make
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
258 changes that you'll have trouble saving afterward. You can make the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
259 buffer writable with @kbd{C-x C-q} (@code{vc-toggle-read-only}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
260 @xref{Misc Buffer}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
261
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
262 @kindex C-x C-r
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
263 @findex find-file-read-only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
264 Occasionally you might want to visit a file as read-only in order to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
265 protect yourself from entering changes accidentally; do so by visiting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
266 the file with the command @kbd{C-x C-r} (@code{find-file-read-only}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
267
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
268 @kindex C-x C-v
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
269 @findex find-alternate-file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
270 If you visit a nonexistent file unintentionally (because you typed the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
271 wrong file name), use the @kbd{C-x C-v} command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
272 (@code{find-alternate-file}) to visit the file you really wanted.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
273 @kbd{C-x C-v} is similar to @kbd{C-x C-f}, but it kills the current
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
274 buffer (after first offering to save it if it is modified). When it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
275 reads the file name to visit, it inserts the entire default file name in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
276 the buffer, with point just after the directory part; this is convenient
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
277 if you made a slight error in typing the name.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
278
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
279 If you find a file which exists but cannot be read, @kbd{C-x C-f}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
280 signals an error.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
281
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
282 @kindex C-x 4 f
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
283 @findex find-file-other-window
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
284 @kbd{C-x 4 f} (@code{find-file-other-window}) is like @kbd{C-x C-f}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
285 except that the buffer containing the specified file is selected in another
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
286 window. The window that was selected before @kbd{C-x 4 f} continues to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
287 show the same buffer it was already showing. If this command is used when
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
288 only one window is being displayed, that window is split in two, with one
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
289 window showing the same buffer as before, and the other one showing the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
290 newly requested file. @xref{Windows}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
291
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
292 @kindex C-x 5 f
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
293 @findex find-file-other-frame
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
294 @kbd{C-x 5 f} (@code{find-file-other-frame}) is similar, but opens a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
295 new frame, or makes visible any existing frame showing the file you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
296 seek. This feature is available only when you are using a window
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
297 system. @xref{Frames}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
298
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
299 @findex find-file-literally
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
300 If you wish to edit a file as a sequence of ASCII characters with no special
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
301 encoding or conversion, use the @kbd{M-x find-file-literally} command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
302 It visits a file, like @kbd{C-x C-f}, but does not do format conversion
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
303 (@pxref{Formatted Text}), character code conversion (@pxref{Coding
33559
c6a08bfab7fd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33278
diff changeset
304 Systems}), or automatic uncompression (@pxref{Compressed Files}), and
c6a08bfab7fd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33278
diff changeset
305 does not add a final newline because of @code{require-final-newline}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
306 If you already have visited the same file in the usual (non-literal)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
307 manner, this command asks you whether to visit it literally instead.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
308
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
309 @vindex find-file-hooks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
310 @vindex find-file-not-found-hooks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
311 Two special hook variables allow extensions to modify the operation of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
312 visiting files. Visiting a file that does not exist runs the functions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
313 in the list @code{find-file-not-found-hooks}; this variable holds a list
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
314 of functions, and the functions are called one by one (with no
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
315 arguments) until one of them returns non-@code{nil}. This is not a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
316 normal hook, and the name ends in @samp{-hooks} rather than @samp{-hook}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
317 to indicate that fact.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
318
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
319 Any visiting of a file, whether extant or not, expects
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
320 @code{find-file-hooks} to contain a list of functions, and calls them
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
321 all, one by one, with no arguments. This variable is really a normal
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
322 hook, but it has an abnormal name for historical compatibility. In the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
323 case of a nonexistent file, the @code{find-file-not-found-hooks} are run
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
324 first. @xref{Hooks}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
325
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
326 There are several ways to specify automatically the major mode for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
327 editing the file (@pxref{Choosing Modes}), and to specify local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
328 variables defined for that file (@pxref{File Variables}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
329
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
330 @node Saving
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
331 @section Saving Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
332
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
333 @dfn{Saving} a buffer in Emacs means writing its contents back into the file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
334 that was visited in the buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
335
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
336 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
337 @item C-x C-s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
338 Save the current buffer in its visited file (@code{save-buffer}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
339 @item C-x s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
340 Save any or all buffers in their visited files (@code{save-some-buffers}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
341 @item M-~
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
342 Forget that the current buffer has been changed (@code{not-modified}).
29556
f973bf66d321 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
343 With prefix argument (@kbd{C-u}), mark the current buffer as changed.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
344 @item C-x C-w
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
345 Save the current buffer in a specified file (@code{write-file}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
346 @item M-x set-visited-file-name
36316
d79558eaaecb (Saveing): Fix "file the name". From Nelson H. F. Beebe
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36274
diff changeset
347 Change the file name under which the current buffer will be saved.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
348 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
349
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
350 @kindex C-x C-s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
351 @findex save-buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
352 When you wish to save the file and make your changes permanent, type
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
353 @kbd{C-x C-s} (@code{save-buffer}). After saving is finished, @kbd{C-x C-s}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
354 displays a message like this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
355
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
356 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
357 Wrote /u/rms/gnu/gnu.tasks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
358 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
359
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
360 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
361 If the selected buffer is not modified (no changes have been made in it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
362 since the buffer was created or last saved), saving is not really done,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
363 because it would have no effect. Instead, @kbd{C-x C-s} displays a message
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
364 like this in the echo area:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
365
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
366 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
367 (No changes need to be saved)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
368 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
369
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
370 @kindex C-x s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
371 @findex save-some-buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
372 The command @kbd{C-x s} (@code{save-some-buffers}) offers to save any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
373 or all modified buffers. It asks you what to do with each buffer. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
374 possible responses are analogous to those of @code{query-replace}:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
375
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
376 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
377 @item y
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
378 Save this buffer and ask about the rest of the buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
379 @item n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
380 Don't save this buffer, but ask about the rest of the buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
381 @item !
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
382 Save this buffer and all the rest with no more questions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
383 @c following generates acceptable underfull hbox
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
384 @item @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
385 Terminate @code{save-some-buffers} without any more saving.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
386 @item .
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
387 Save this buffer, then exit @code{save-some-buffers} without even asking
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
388 about other buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
389 @item C-r
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
390 View the buffer that you are currently being asked about. When you exit
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
391 View mode, you get back to @code{save-some-buffers}, which asks the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
392 question again.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
393 @item C-h
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
394 Display a help message about these options.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
395 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
396
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
397 @kbd{C-x C-c}, the key sequence to exit Emacs, invokes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
398 @code{save-some-buffers} and therefore asks the same questions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
399
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
400 @kindex M-~
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
401 @findex not-modified
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
402 If you have changed a buffer but you do not want to save the changes,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
403 you should take some action to prevent it. Otherwise, each time you use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
404 @kbd{C-x s} or @kbd{C-x C-c}, you are liable to save this buffer by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
405 mistake. One thing you can do is type @kbd{M-~} (@code{not-modified}),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
406 which clears out the indication that the buffer is modified. If you do
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
407 this, none of the save commands will believe that the buffer needs to be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
408 saved. (@samp{~} is often used as a mathematical symbol for `not'; thus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
409 @kbd{M-~} is `not', metafied.) You could also use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
410 @code{set-visited-file-name} (see below) to mark the buffer as visiting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
411 a different file name, one which is not in use for anything important.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
412 Alternatively, you can cancel all the changes made since the file was
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
413 visited or saved, by reading the text from the file again. This is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
414 called @dfn{reverting}. @xref{Reverting}. You could also undo all the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
415 changes by repeating the undo command @kbd{C-x u} until you have undone
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
416 all the changes; but reverting is easier.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
417
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
418 @findex set-visited-file-name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
419 @kbd{M-x set-visited-file-name} alters the name of the file that the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
420 current buffer is visiting. It reads the new file name using the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
421 minibuffer. Then it specifies the visited file name and changes the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
422 buffer name correspondingly (as long as the new name is not in use).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
423 @code{set-visited-file-name} does not save the buffer in the newly
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
424 visited file; it just alters the records inside Emacs in case you do
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
425 save later. It also marks the buffer as ``modified'' so that @kbd{C-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
426 C-s} in that buffer @emph{will} save.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
427
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
428 @kindex C-x C-w
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
429 @findex write-file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
430 If you wish to mark the buffer as visiting a different file and save it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
431 right away, use @kbd{C-x C-w} (@code{write-file}). It is precisely
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
432 equivalent to @code{set-visited-file-name} followed by @kbd{C-x C-s}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
433 @kbd{C-x C-s} used on a buffer that is not visiting a file has the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
434 same effect as @kbd{C-x C-w}; that is, it reads a file name, marks the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
435 buffer as visiting that file, and saves it there. The default file name in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
436 a buffer that is not visiting a file is made by combining the buffer name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
437 with the buffer's default directory.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
438
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
439 If the new file name implies a major mode, then @kbd{C-x C-w} switches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
440 to that major mode, in most cases. The command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
441 @code{set-visited-file-name} also does this. @xref{Choosing Modes}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
442
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
443 If Emacs is about to save a file and sees that the date of the latest
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
444 version on disk does not match what Emacs last read or wrote, Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
445 notifies you of this fact, because it probably indicates a problem caused
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
446 by simultaneous editing and requires your immediate attention.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
447 @xref{Interlocking,, Simultaneous Editing}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
448
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
449 @vindex require-final-newline
36319
77c56d3f0b8f (Saving): Update the documentation of require-final-newline.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36316
diff changeset
450 If the value of the variable @code{require-final-newline} is @code{t},
77c56d3f0b8f (Saving): Update the documentation of require-final-newline.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36316
diff changeset
451 Emacs silently puts a newline at the end of any file that doesn't
77c56d3f0b8f (Saving): Update the documentation of require-final-newline.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36316
diff changeset
452 already end in one, every time a file is saved or written. If the value
77c56d3f0b8f (Saving): Update the documentation of require-final-newline.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36316
diff changeset
453 is @code{nil}, Emacs leaves the end of the file unchanged; if it's
77c56d3f0b8f (Saving): Update the documentation of require-final-newline.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36316
diff changeset
454 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, Emacs asks you whether to add a
77c56d3f0b8f (Saving): Update the documentation of require-final-newline.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36316
diff changeset
455 newline. The default is @code{nil}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
456
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
457 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
458 * Backup:: How Emacs saves the old version of your file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
459 * Interlocking:: How Emacs protects against simultaneous editing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
460 of one file by two users.
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
461 * Shadowing: File Shadowing.
36185
62cf166239f3 Change in quoting.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36155
diff changeset
462 Copying files to "shadows" automatically.
35524
91c357a883aa (Time Stamps): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35337
diff changeset
463 * Time Stamps:: Emacs can update time stamps on saved files.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
464 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
465
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
466 @node Backup
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
467 @subsection Backup Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
468 @cindex backup file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
469 @vindex make-backup-files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
470 @vindex vc-make-backup-files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
471
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
472 On most operating systems, rewriting a file automatically destroys all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
473 record of what the file used to contain. Thus, saving a file from Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
474 throws away the old contents of the file---or it would, except that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
475 Emacs carefully copies the old contents to another file, called the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
476 @dfn{backup} file, before actually saving.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
477
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
478 For most files, the variable @code{make-backup-files} determines
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
479 whether to make backup files. On most operating systems, its default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
480 value is @code{t}, so that Emacs does write backup files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
481
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
482 For files managed by a version control system (@pxref{Version
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
483 Control}), the variable @code{vc-make-backup-files} determines whether
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
484 to make backup files. By default, it is @code{nil}, since backup files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
485 are redundant when you store all the previous versions in a version
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
486 control system. @xref{General VC Options}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
487
28526
297e03ccd7e6 (Backup): backup-enable-predicate.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28327
diff changeset
488 @vindex backup-enable-predicate
297e03ccd7e6 (Backup): backup-enable-predicate.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28327
diff changeset
489 @vindex temporary-file-directory
297e03ccd7e6 (Backup): backup-enable-predicate.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28327
diff changeset
490 @vindex small-temporary-file-directory
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
491 The default value of the @code{backup-enable-predicate} variable
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
492 prevents backup files being written for files in the directories used
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
493 for temporary files, specified by @code{temporary-file-directory} or
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
494 @code{small-temporary-file-directory}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
495
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
496 At your option, Emacs can keep either a single backup file or a series of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
497 numbered backup files for each file that you edit.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
498
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
499 Emacs makes a backup for a file only the first time the file is saved
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
500 from one buffer. No matter how many times you save a file, its backup file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
501 continues to contain the contents from before the file was visited.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
502 Normally this means that the backup file contains the contents from before
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
503 the current editing session; however, if you kill the buffer and then visit
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
504 the file again, a new backup file will be made by the next save.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
505
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
506 You can also explicitly request making another backup file from a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
507 buffer even though it has already been saved at least once. If you save
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
508 the buffer with @kbd{C-u C-x C-s}, the version thus saved will be made
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
509 into a backup file if you save the buffer again. @kbd{C-u C-u C-x C-s}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
510 saves the buffer, but first makes the previous file contents into a new
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
511 backup file. @kbd{C-u C-u C-u C-x C-s} does both things: it makes a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
512 backup from the previous contents, and arranges to make another from the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
513 newly saved contents, if you save again.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
514
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
515 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
516 * Names: Backup Names. How backup files are named;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
517 choosing single or numbered backup files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
518 * Deletion: Backup Deletion. Emacs deletes excess numbered backups.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
519 * Copying: Backup Copying. Backups can be made by copying or renaming.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
520 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
521
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
522 @node Backup Names
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
523 @subsubsection Single or Numbered Backups
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
524
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
525 If you choose to have a single backup file (this is the default),
28526
297e03ccd7e6 (Backup): backup-enable-predicate.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28327
diff changeset
526 the backup file's name is normally constructed by appending @samp{~} to the
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
527 file name being edited; thus, the backup file for @file{eval.c} would
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
528 be @file{eval.c~}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
529
28526
297e03ccd7e6 (Backup): backup-enable-predicate.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28327
diff changeset
530 @vindex make-backup-file-name-function
297e03ccd7e6 (Backup): backup-enable-predicate.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28327
diff changeset
531 @vindex backup-directory-alist
297e03ccd7e6 (Backup): backup-enable-predicate.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28327
diff changeset
532 You can change this behaviour by defining the variable
297e03ccd7e6 (Backup): backup-enable-predicate.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28327
diff changeset
533 @code{make-backup-file-name-function} to a suitable function.
297e03ccd7e6 (Backup): backup-enable-predicate.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28327
diff changeset
534 Alternatively you can customize the variable
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
535 @var{backup-directory-alist} to specify that files matching certain
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
536 patterns should be backed up in specific directories.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
537
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
538 A typical use is to add an element @code{("." . @var{dir})} to make
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
539 all backups in the directory with absolute name @var{dir}; Emacs
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
540 modifies the backup file names to avoid clashes between files with the
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
541 same names originating in different directories. Alternatively,
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
542 adding, say, @code{("." ".~")} would make backups in the invisible
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
543 subdirectory @file{.~} of the original file's directory. Emacs
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
544 creates the directory, if necessary, to make the backup.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
545
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
546 If access control stops Emacs from writing backup files under the usual
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
547 names, it writes the backup file as @file{%backup%~} in your home
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
548 directory. Only one such file can exist, so only the most recently
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
549 made such backup is available.
28526
297e03ccd7e6 (Backup): backup-enable-predicate.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28327
diff changeset
550
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
551 If you choose to have a series of numbered backup files, backup file
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
552 names contain @samp{.~}, the number, and another @samp{~} after the
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
553 original file name. Thus, the backup files of @file{eval.c} would be
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
554 called @file{eval.c.~1~}, @file{eval.c.~2~}, and so on, all the way
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
555 through names like @file{eval.c.~259~} and beyond. The variable
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
556 @code{backup-directory-alist} applies to numbered backups just as
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
557 usual.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
558
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
559 @vindex version-control
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
560 The choice of single backup or numbered backups is controlled by the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
561 variable @code{version-control}. Its possible values are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
562
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
563 @table @code
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
564 @item t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
565 Make numbered backups.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
566 @item nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
567 Make numbered backups for files that have numbered backups already.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
568 Otherwise, make single backups.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
569 @item never
36322
b95226aa58b9 (Backup names): Fix "Do not in any case". From Nelson H. F. Beebe
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36319
diff changeset
570 Never make numbered backups; always make single backups.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
571 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
572
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
573 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
574 You can set @code{version-control} locally in an individual buffer to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
575 control the making of backups for that buffer's file. For example,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
576 Rmail mode locally sets @code{version-control} to @code{never} to make sure
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
577 that there is only one backup for an Rmail file. @xref{Locals}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
578
29107
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28671
diff changeset
579 @cindex @env{VERSION_CONTROL} environment variable
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28671
diff changeset
580 If you set the environment variable @env{VERSION_CONTROL}, to tell
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
581 various GNU utilities what to do with backup files, Emacs also obeys the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
582 environment variable by setting the Lisp variable @code{version-control}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
583 accordingly at startup. If the environment variable's value is @samp{t}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
584 or @samp{numbered}, then @code{version-control} becomes @code{t}; if the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
585 value is @samp{nil} or @samp{existing}, then @code{version-control}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
586 becomes @code{nil}; if it is @samp{never} or @samp{simple}, then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
587 @code{version-control} becomes @code{never}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
588
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
589 @node Backup Deletion
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
590 @subsubsection Automatic Deletion of Backups
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
591
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
592 To prevent unlimited consumption of disk space, Emacs can delete numbered
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
593 backup versions automatically. Generally Emacs keeps the first few backups
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
594 and the latest few backups, deleting any in between. This happens every
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
595 time a new backup is made.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
596
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
597 @vindex kept-old-versions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
598 @vindex kept-new-versions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
599 The two variables @code{kept-old-versions} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
600 @code{kept-new-versions} control this deletion. Their values are,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
601 respectively the number of oldest (lowest-numbered) backups to keep and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
602 the number of newest (highest-numbered) ones to keep, each time a new
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
603 backup is made. Recall that these values are used just after a new
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
604 backup version is made; that newly made backup is included in the count
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
605 in @code{kept-new-versions}. By default, both variables are 2.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
606
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
607 @vindex delete-old-versions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
608 If @code{delete-old-versions} is non-@code{nil}, the excess
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
609 middle versions are deleted without a murmur. If it is @code{nil}, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
610 default, then you are asked whether the excess middle versions should
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
611 really be deleted.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
612
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
613 Dired's @kbd{.} (Period) command can also be used to delete old versions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
614 @xref{Dired Deletion}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
615
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
616 @node Backup Copying
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
617 @subsubsection Copying vs.@: Renaming
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
618
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
619 Backup files can be made by copying the old file or by renaming it. This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
620 makes a difference when the old file has multiple names. If the old file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
621 is renamed into the backup file, then the alternate names become names for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
622 the backup file. If the old file is copied instead, then the alternate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
623 names remain names for the file that you are editing, and the contents
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
624 accessed by those names will be the new contents.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
625
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
626 The method of making a backup file may also affect the file's owner
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
627 and group. If copying is used, these do not change. If renaming is used,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
628 you become the file's owner, and the file's group becomes the default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
629 (different operating systems have different defaults for the group).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
630
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
631 Having the owner change is usually a good idea, because then the owner
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
632 always shows who last edited the file. Also, the owners of the backups
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
633 show who produced those versions. Occasionally there is a file whose
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
634 owner should not change; it is a good idea for such files to contain
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
635 local variable lists to set @code{backup-by-copying-when-mismatch}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
636 locally (@pxref{File Variables}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
637
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
638 @vindex backup-by-copying
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
639 @vindex backup-by-copying-when-linked
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
640 @vindex backup-by-copying-when-mismatch
31043
31a21ae1de1f Document backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29683
diff changeset
641 @vindex backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch
31a21ae1de1f Document backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29683
diff changeset
642 @cindex file ownership, and backup
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
643 @cindex backup, and user-id
31043
31a21ae1de1f Document backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29683
diff changeset
644 The choice of renaming or copying is controlled by four variables.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
645 Renaming is the default choice. If the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
646 @code{backup-by-copying} is non-@code{nil}, copying is used. Otherwise,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
647 if the variable @code{backup-by-copying-when-linked} is non-@code{nil},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
648 then copying is used for files that have multiple names, but renaming
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
649 may still be used when the file being edited has only one name. If the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
650 variable @code{backup-by-copying-when-mismatch} is non-@code{nil}, then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
651 copying is used if renaming would cause the file's owner or group to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
652 change. @code{backup-by-copying-when-mismatch} is @code{t} by default
31043
31a21ae1de1f Document backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29683
diff changeset
653 if you start Emacs as the superuser. The fourth variable,
31a21ae1de1f Document backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29683
diff changeset
654 @code{backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch}, gives the highest
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
655 numeric user-id for which @code{backup-by-copying-when-mismatch} will be
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
656 forced on. This is useful when low-numbered user-id are assigned to
31043
31a21ae1de1f Document backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29683
diff changeset
657 special system users, such as @code{root}, @code{bin}, @code{daemon},
31a21ae1de1f Document backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29683
diff changeset
658 etc., which must maintain ownership of files.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
659
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
660 When a file is managed with a version control system (@pxref{Version
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
661 Control}), Emacs does not normally make backups in the usual way for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
662 that file. But check-in and check-out are similar in some ways to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
663 making backups. One unfortunate similarity is that these operations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
664 typically break hard links, disconnecting the file name you visited from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
665 any alternate names for the same file. This has nothing to do with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
666 Emacs---the version control system does it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
667
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
668 @node Interlocking
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
669 @subsection Protection against Simultaneous Editing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
670
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
671 @cindex file dates
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
672 @cindex simultaneous editing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
673 Simultaneous editing occurs when two users visit the same file, both
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
674 make changes, and then both save them. If nobody were informed that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
675 this was happening, whichever user saved first would later find that his
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
676 changes were lost.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
677
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
678 On some systems, Emacs notices immediately when the second user starts
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
679 to change the file, and issues an immediate warning. On all systems,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
680 Emacs checks when you save the file, and warns if you are about to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
681 overwrite another user's changes. You can prevent loss of the other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
682 user's work by taking the proper corrective action instead of saving the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
683 file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
684
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
685 @findex ask-user-about-lock
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
686 @cindex locking files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
687 When you make the first modification in an Emacs buffer that is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
688 visiting a file, Emacs records that the file is @dfn{locked} by you.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
689 (It does this by creating a symbolic link in the same directory with a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
690 different name.) Emacs removes the lock when you save the changes. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
691 idea is that the file is locked whenever an Emacs buffer visiting it has
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
692 unsaved changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
693
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
694 @cindex collision
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
695 If you begin to modify the buffer while the visited file is locked by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
696 someone else, this constitutes a @dfn{collision}. When Emacs detects a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
697 collision, it asks you what to do, by calling the Lisp function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
698 @code{ask-user-about-lock}. You can redefine this function for the sake
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
699 of customization. The standard definition of this function asks you a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
700 question and accepts three possible answers:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
701
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
702 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
703 @item s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
704 Steal the lock. Whoever was already changing the file loses the lock,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
705 and you gain the lock.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
706 @item p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
707 Proceed. Go ahead and edit the file despite its being locked by someone else.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
708 @item q
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
709 Quit. This causes an error (@code{file-locked}) and the modification you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
710 were trying to make in the buffer does not actually take place.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
711 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
712
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
713 Note that locking works on the basis of a file name; if a file has
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
714 multiple names, Emacs does not realize that the two names are the same file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
715 and cannot prevent two users from editing it simultaneously under different
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
716 names. However, basing locking on names means that Emacs can interlock the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
717 editing of new files that will not really exist until they are saved.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
718
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
719 Some systems are not configured to allow Emacs to make locks, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
720 there are cases where lock files cannot be written. In these cases,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
721 Emacs cannot detect trouble in advance, but it still can detect the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
722 collision when you try to save a file and overwrite someone else's
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
723 changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
724
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
725 If Emacs or the operating system crashes, this may leave behind lock
36327
f32c31c60f60 (Interlocking): Fix wording of "So you may".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36326
diff changeset
726 files which are stale, so you may occasionally get warnings about
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
727 spurious collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
728 just use @kbd{p} to tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
729
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
730 Every time Emacs saves a buffer, it first checks the last-modification
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
731 date of the existing file on disk to verify that it has not changed since the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
732 file was last visited or saved. If the date does not match, it implies
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
733 that changes were made in the file in some other way, and these changes are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
734 about to be lost if Emacs actually does save. To prevent this, Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
735 prints a warning message and asks for confirmation before saving.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
736 Occasionally you will know why the file was changed and know that it does
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
737 not matter; then you can answer @kbd{yes} and proceed. Otherwise, you should
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
738 cancel the save with @kbd{C-g} and investigate the situation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
739
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
740 The first thing you should do when notified that simultaneous editing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
741 has already taken place is to list the directory with @kbd{C-u C-x C-d}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
742 (@pxref{Directories}). This shows the file's current author. You
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
743 should attempt to contact him to warn him not to continue editing.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
744 Often the next step is to save the contents of your Emacs buffer under a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
745 different name, and use @code{diff} to compare the two files.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
746
31076
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
747 @node File Shadowing
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
748 @subsection Shadowing Files
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
749 @cindex shadow files
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
750 @cindex file shadows
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
751
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
752 @table @kbd
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
753 @item M-x shadow-initialize
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
754 Set up file shadowing.
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
755 @item M-x shadow-define-literal-group
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
756 Declare a single file to be shared between sites.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
757 @item M-x shadow-define-regexp-group
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
758 Make all files that match each of a group of files be shared between hosts.
31076
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
759 @item M-x shadow-define-cluster @key{RET} @var{name} @key{RET}
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
760 Define a shadow file cluster @var{name}.
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
761 @item M-x shadow-copy-files
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
762 Copy all pending shadow files.
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
763 @item M-x shadow-cancel
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
764 Cancel the instruction to shadow some files.
31076
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
765 @end table
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
766
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
767 You can arrange to keep identical @dfn{shadow} copies of certain files
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
768 in more than one place---possibly on different machines. To do this,
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
769 first you must set up a @dfn{shadow file group}, which is a set of
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
770 identically-named files shared between a list of sites. The file
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
771 group is permanent and applies to further Emacs sessions as well as
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
772 the current one. Once the group is set up, every time you exit Emacs,
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
773 it will copy the file you edited to the other files in its group. You
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
774 can also do the copying without exiting Emacs, by typing @kbd{M-x
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
775 shadow-copy-files}.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
776
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
777 To set up a file group, use @kbd{M-x shadow-define-literal-group} or
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
778 @kbd{M-x shadow-define-regexp-group}. See their documentation strings
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
779 for further information.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
780
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
781 Before copying a file to its shadows, Emacs asks for confirmation.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
782 You can answer ``no'' to bypass copying of this file, this time. If
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
783 you want to cancel the shadowing permanently for a certain file, use
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
784 @kbd{M-x shadow-cancel} to eliminate or change the shadow file group.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
785
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
786 A @dfn{shadow cluster} is a group of hosts that share directories, so
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
787 that copying to or from one of them is sufficient to update the file
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
788 on all of them. Each shadow cluster has a name, and specifies the
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
789 network address of a primary host (the one we copy files to), and a
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
790 regular expression that matches the hostnames of all the other hosts
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
791 in the cluster. You can define a shadow cluster with @kbd{M-x
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
792 shadow-define-cluster}.
31076
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
793
35524
91c357a883aa (Time Stamps): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35337
diff changeset
794 @node Time Stamps
91c357a883aa (Time Stamps): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35337
diff changeset
795 @subsection Updating Time Stamps Automatically
91c357a883aa (Time Stamps): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35337
diff changeset
796 @findex time-stamp
91c357a883aa (Time Stamps): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35337
diff changeset
797 @cindex time stamps
91c357a883aa (Time Stamps): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35337
diff changeset
798 @cindex modification dates
35620
654bde0f95a6 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35524
diff changeset
799 @cindex locale, date format
35524
91c357a883aa (Time Stamps): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35337
diff changeset
800
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
801 You can arrange put a time stamp in a file, so that it will be updated
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
802 automatically each time you edit and save the file. The time stamp
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
803 has to be in the first eight lines of the file, and you should
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
804 insert it like this:
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
805
35524
91c357a883aa (Time Stamps): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35337
diff changeset
806 @example
91c357a883aa (Time Stamps): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35337
diff changeset
807 Time-stamp: <>
91c357a883aa (Time Stamps): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35337
diff changeset
808 @end example
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
809
35524
91c357a883aa (Time Stamps): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35337
diff changeset
810 @noindent
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
811 or like this:
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
812
35524
91c357a883aa (Time Stamps): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35337
diff changeset
813 @example
91c357a883aa (Time Stamps): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35337
diff changeset
814 Time-stamp: ""
91c357a883aa (Time Stamps): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35337
diff changeset
815 @end example
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
816
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
817 Then add the hook function @code{time-stamp} to the hook
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
818 @code{write-file-hooks}; that hook function will automatically update
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
819 the time stamp, inserting the current date and time when you save the
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
820 file. You can also use the command @kbd{M-x time-stamp} to update the
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
821 time stamp manually. For other customizations, see the Custom group
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
822 @code{time-stamp}. Note that non-numeric fields in the time stamp are
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
823 formatted according to your locale setting (@pxref{Environment}).
35524
91c357a883aa (Time Stamps): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35337
diff changeset
824
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
825 @node Reverting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
826 @section Reverting a Buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
827 @findex revert-buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
828 @cindex drastic changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
830 If you have made extensive changes to a file and then change your mind
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
831 about them, you can get rid of them by reading in the previous version
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
832 of the file. To do this, use @kbd{M-x revert-buffer}, which operates on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
833 the current buffer. Since reverting a buffer unintentionally could lose
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
834 a lot of work, you must confirm this command with @kbd{yes}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
835
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
836 @code{revert-buffer} keeps point at the same distance (measured in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
837 characters) from the beginning of the file. If the file was edited only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
838 slightly, you will be at approximately the same piece of text after
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
839 reverting as before. If you have made drastic changes, the same value of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
840 point in the old file may address a totally different piece of text.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
841
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
842 Reverting marks the buffer as ``not modified'' until another change is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
843 made.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
844
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
845 Some kinds of buffers whose contents reflect data bases other than files,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
846 such as Dired buffers, can also be reverted. For them, reverting means
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
847 recalculating their contents from the appropriate data base. Buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
848 created explicitly with @kbd{C-x b} cannot be reverted; @code{revert-buffer}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
849 reports an error when asked to do so.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
850
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
851 @vindex revert-without-query
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
852 When you edit a file that changes automatically and frequently---for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
853 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run---it may be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
854 useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you, whenever you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
855 visit the file again with @kbd{C-x C-f}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
856
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
857 To request this behavior, set the variable @code{revert-without-query}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
858 to a list of regular expressions. When a file name matches one of these
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
859 regular expressions, @code{find-file} and @code{revert-buffer} will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
860 revert it automatically if it has changed---provided the buffer itself
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
861 is not modified. (If you have edited the text, it would be wrong to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
862 discard your changes.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
863
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
864 @node Auto Save
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
865 @section Auto-Saving: Protection Against Disasters
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
866 @cindex Auto Save mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
867 @cindex mode, Auto Save
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
868 @cindex crashes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
869
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
870 Emacs saves all the visited files from time to time (based on counting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
871 your keystrokes) without being asked. This is called @dfn{auto-saving}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
872 It prevents you from losing more than a limited amount of work if the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
873 system crashes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
874
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
875 When Emacs determines that it is time for auto-saving, each buffer is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
876 considered, and is auto-saved if auto-saving is turned on for it and it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
877 has been changed since the last time it was auto-saved. The message
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
878 @samp{Auto-saving...} is displayed in the echo area during auto-saving,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
879 if any files are actually auto-saved. Errors occurring during
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
880 auto-saving are caught so that they do not interfere with the execution
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
881 of commands you have been typing.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
882
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
883 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
884 * Files: Auto Save Files. The file where auto-saved changes are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
885 actually made until you save the file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
886 * Control: Auto Save Control. Controlling when and how often to auto-save.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
887 * Recover:: Recovering text from auto-save files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
888 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
889
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
890 @node Auto Save Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
891 @subsection Auto-Save Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
892
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
893 Auto-saving does not normally save in the files that you visited, because
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
894 it can be very undesirable to save a program that is in an inconsistent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
895 state when you have made half of a planned change. Instead, auto-saving
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
896 is done in a different file called the @dfn{auto-save file}, and the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
897 visited file is changed only when you request saving explicitly (such as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
898 with @kbd{C-x C-s}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
899
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
900 Normally, the auto-save file name is made by appending @samp{#} to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
901 front and rear of the visited file name. Thus, a buffer visiting file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
902 @file{foo.c} is auto-saved in a file @file{#foo.c#}. Most buffers that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
903 are not visiting files are auto-saved only if you request it explicitly;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
904 when they are auto-saved, the auto-save file name is made by appending
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
905 @samp{#%} to the front and @samp{#} to the rear of buffer name. For
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
906 example, the @samp{*mail*} buffer in which you compose messages to be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
907 sent is auto-saved in a file named @file{#%*mail*#}. Auto-save file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
908 names are made this way unless you reprogram parts of Emacs to do
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
909 something different (the functions @code{make-auto-save-file-name} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
910 @code{auto-save-file-name-p}). The file name to be used for auto-saving
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
911 in a buffer is calculated when auto-saving is turned on in that buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
912
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
913 When you delete a substantial part of the text in a large buffer, auto
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
914 save turns off temporarily in that buffer. This is because if you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
915 deleted the text unintentionally, you might find the auto-save file more
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
916 useful if it contains the deleted text. To reenable auto-saving after
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
917 this happens, save the buffer with @kbd{C-x C-s}, or use @kbd{C-u 1 M-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
918 auto-save}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
919
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
920 @vindex auto-save-visited-file-name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
921 If you want auto-saving to be done in the visited file, set the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
922 @code{auto-save-visited-file-name} to be non-@code{nil}. In this mode,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
923 there is really no difference between auto-saving and explicit saving.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
924
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
925 @vindex delete-auto-save-files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
926 A buffer's auto-save file is deleted when you save the buffer in its
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
927 visited file. To inhibit this, set the variable @code{delete-auto-save-files}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
928 to @code{nil}. Changing the visited file name with @kbd{C-x C-w} or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
929 @code{set-visited-file-name} renames any auto-save file to go with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
930 the new visited name.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
931
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
932 @node Auto Save Control
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
933 @subsection Controlling Auto-Saving
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
934
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
935 @vindex auto-save-default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
936 @findex auto-save-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
937 Each time you visit a file, auto-saving is turned on for that file's
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
938 buffer if the variable @code{auto-save-default} is non-@code{nil} (but not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
939 in batch mode; @pxref{Entering Emacs}). The default for this variable is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
940 @code{t}, so auto-saving is the usual practice for file-visiting buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
941 Auto-saving can be turned on or off for any existing buffer with the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
942 command @kbd{M-x auto-save-mode}. Like other minor mode commands, @kbd{M-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
943 auto-save-mode} turns auto-saving on with a positive argument, off with a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
944 zero or negative argument; with no argument, it toggles.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
945
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
946 @vindex auto-save-interval
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
947 Emacs does auto-saving periodically based on counting how many characters
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
948 you have typed since the last time auto-saving was done. The variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
949 @code{auto-save-interval} specifies how many characters there are between
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
950 auto-saves. By default, it is 300.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
951
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
952 @vindex auto-save-timeout
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
953 Auto-saving also takes place when you stop typing for a while. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
954 variable @code{auto-save-timeout} says how many seconds Emacs should
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
955 wait before it does an auto save (and perhaps also a garbage
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
956 collection). (The actual time period is longer if the current buffer is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
957 long; this is a heuristic which aims to keep out of your way when you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
958 are editing long buffers, in which auto-save takes an appreciable amount
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
959 of time.) Auto-saving during idle periods accomplishes two things:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
960 first, it makes sure all your work is saved if you go away from the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
961 terminal for a while; second, it may avoid some auto-saving while you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
962 are actually typing.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
963
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
964 Emacs also does auto-saving whenever it gets a fatal error. This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
965 includes killing the Emacs job with a shell command such as @samp{kill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
966 %emacs}, or disconnecting a phone line or network connection.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
967
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
968 @findex do-auto-save
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
969 You can request an auto-save explicitly with the command @kbd{M-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
970 do-auto-save}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
971
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
972 @node Recover
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
973 @subsection Recovering Data from Auto-Saves
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
974
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
975 @findex recover-file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
976 You can use the contents of an auto-save file to recover from a loss
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
977 of data with the command @kbd{M-x recover-file @key{RET} @var{file}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
978 @key{RET}}. This visits @var{file} and then (after your confirmation)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
979 restores the contents from its auto-save file @file{#@var{file}#}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
980 You can then save with @kbd{C-x C-s} to put the recovered text into
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
981 @var{file} itself. For example, to recover file @file{foo.c} from its
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
982 auto-save file @file{#foo.c#}, do:@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
983
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
984 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
985 M-x recover-file @key{RET} foo.c @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
986 yes @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
987 C-x C-s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
988 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
989
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
990 Before asking for confirmation, @kbd{M-x recover-file} displays a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
991 directory listing describing the specified file and the auto-save file,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
992 so you can compare their sizes and dates. If the auto-save file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
993 is older, @kbd{M-x recover-file} does not offer to read it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
994
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
995 @findex recover-session
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
996 If Emacs or the computer crashes, you can recover all the files you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
997 were editing from their auto save files with the command @kbd{M-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
998 recover-session}. This first shows you a list of recorded interrupted
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
999 sessions. Move point to the one you choose, and type @kbd{C-c C-c}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1000
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1001 Then @code{recover-session} asks about each of the files that were
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1002 being edited during that session, asking whether to recover that file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1003 If you answer @kbd{y}, it calls @code{recover-file}, which works in its
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1004 normal fashion. It shows the dates of the original file and its
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1005 auto-save file, and asks once again whether to recover that file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1006
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1007 When @code{recover-session} is done, the files you've chosen to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1008 recover are present in Emacs buffers. You should then save them. Only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1009 this---saving them---updates the files themselves.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1010
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1011 @vindex auto-save-list-file-prefix
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1012 Emacs records interrupted sessions for later recovery in files named
31076
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
1013 @file{~/.emacs.d/auto-save-list/.saves-@var{pid}-@var{hostname}}. The
35337
d3d87c5d1158 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 34115
diff changeset
1014 @samp{~/.emacs.d/auto-save-list/.saves-} portion of these names comes
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1015 from the value of @code{auto-save-list-file-prefix}. You can record
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1016 sessions in a different place by customizing that variable. If you
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1017 set @code{auto-save-list-file-prefix} to @code{nil} in your
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1018 @file{.emacs} file, sessions are not recorded for recovery.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1019
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1020 @node File Aliases
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1021 @section File Name Aliases
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1022
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1023 Symbolic links and hard links both make it possible for several file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1024 names to refer to the same file. Hard links are alternate names that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1025 refer directly to the file; all the names are equally valid, and no one
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1026 of them is preferred. By contrast, a symbolic link is a kind of defined
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1027 alias: when @file{foo} is a symbolic link to @file{bar}, you can use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1028 either name to refer to the file, but @file{bar} is the real name, while
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1029 @file{foo} is just an alias. More complex cases occur when symbolic
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1030 links point to directories.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1031
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1032 If you visit two names for the same file, normally Emacs makes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1033 two different buffers, but it warns you about the situation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1034
33278
7b666d4d4007 (File Aliases): Change description of find-file-existing-other-name
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 32221
diff changeset
1035 @vindex find-file-existing-other-name
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1036 Normally, if you visit a file which Emacs is already visiting under
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1037 a different name, Emacs displays a message in the echo area and uses
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1038 the existing buffer visiting that file. This can happen on systems
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1039 that support symbolic links, or if you use a long file name on a
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1040 system that truncates long file names. You can disable this feature
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1041 by setting the variable @code{find-file-existing-other-name} to
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1042 @code{nil}. Then if you visit the same file under two different names,
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1043 you get a separate buffer for each file name.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1044
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1045 @vindex find-file-visit-truename
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1046 @cindex truenames of files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1047 @cindex file truenames
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1048 If the variable @code{find-file-visit-truename} is non-@code{nil},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1049 then the file name recorded for a buffer is the file's @dfn{truename}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1050 (made by replacing all symbolic links with their target names), rather
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1051 than the name you specify. Setting @code{find-file-visit-truename} also
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1052 implies the effect of @code{find-file-existing-other-name}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1053
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1054 @node Version Control
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1055 @section Version Control
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1056 @cindex version control
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1057
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1058 @dfn{Version control systems} are packages that can record multiple
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1059 versions of a source file, usually storing the unchanged parts of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1060 file just once. Version control systems also record history information
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1061 such as the creation time of each version, who created it, and a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1062 description of what was changed in that version.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1063
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1064 The Emacs version control interface is called VC. Its commands work
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1065 with three version control systems---RCS, CVS, and SCCS. The GNU
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1066 project recommends RCS and CVS, which are free software and available
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1067 from the Free Software Foundation. We also have free software to
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1068 replace SCCS, known as CSSC; if you are using SCCS and don't want to
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1069 make the incompatible change to RCS or CVS, you can switch to CSSC.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1070
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1071 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1072 * Introduction to VC:: How version control works in general.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1073 * VC Mode Line:: How the mode line shows version control status.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1074 * Basic VC Editing:: How to edit a file under version control.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1075 * Old Versions:: Examining and comparing old versions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1076 * Secondary VC Commands:: The commands used a little less frequently.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1077 * Branches:: Multiple lines of development.
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1078 * Remote Repositories:: Efficient access to remote CVS servers.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1079 * Snapshots:: Sets of file versions treated as a unit.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1080 * Miscellaneous VC:: Various other commands and features of VC.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1081 * Customizing VC:: Variables that change VC's behavior.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1082 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1083
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1084 @node Introduction to VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1085 @subsection Introduction to Version Control
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1086
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1087 VC allows you to use a version control system from within Emacs,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1088 integrating the version control operations smoothly with editing. VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1089 provides a uniform interface to version control, so that regardless of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1090 which version control system is in use, you can use it the same way.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1091
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1092 This section provides a general overview of version control, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1093 describes the version control systems that VC supports. You can skip
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1094 this section if you are already familiar with the version control system
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1095 you want to use.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1096
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1097 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1098 * Version Systems:: Supported version control back-end systems.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1099 * VC Concepts:: Words and concepts related to version control.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1100 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1101
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1102 @node Version Systems
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1103 @subsubsection Supported Version Control Systems
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1104
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1105 @cindex RCS
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1106 @cindex back end (version control)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1107 VC currently works with three different version control systems or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1108 ``back ends'': RCS, CVS, and SCCS.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1109
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1110 RCS is a free version control system that is available from the Free
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1111 Software Foundation. It is perhaps the most mature of the supported
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1112 back ends, and the VC commands are conceptually closest to RCS. Almost
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1113 everything you can do with RCS can be done through VC.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1114
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1115 @cindex CVS
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1116 CVS is built on top of RCS, and extends the features of RCS, allowing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1117 for more sophisticated release management, and concurrent multi-user
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1118 development. VC supports basic editing operations under CVS, but for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1119 some less common tasks you still need to call CVS from the command line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1120 Note also that before using CVS you must set up a repository, which is a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1121 subject too complex to treat here.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1122
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1123 @cindex SCCS
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1124 SCCS is a proprietary but widely used version control system. In
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1125 terms of capabilities, it is the weakest of the three that VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1126 supports. VC compensates for certain features missing in SCCS
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1127 (snapshots, for example) by implementing them itself, but some other VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1128 features, such as multiple branches, are not available with SCCS. You
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1129 should use SCCS only if for some reason you cannot use RCS.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1130
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1131 @node VC Concepts
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1132 @subsubsection Concepts of Version Control
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1133
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1134 @cindex master file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1135 @cindex registered file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1136 When a file is under version control, we also say that it is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1137 @dfn{registered} in the version control system. Each registered file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1138 has a corresponding @dfn{master file} which represents the file's
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1139 present state plus its change history---enough to reconstruct the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1140 current version or any earlier version. Usually the master file also
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1141 records a @dfn{log entry} for each version, describing in words what was
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1142 changed in that version.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1143
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1144 @cindex work file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1145 @cindex checking out files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1146 The file that is maintained under version control is sometimes called
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1147 the @dfn{work file} corresponding to its master file. You edit the work
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1148 file and make changes in it, as you would with an ordinary file. (With
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1149 SCCS and RCS, you must @dfn{lock} the file before you start to edit it.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1150 After you are done with a set of changes, you @dfn{check the file in},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1151 which records the changes in the master file, along with a log entry for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1152 them.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1153
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1154 With CVS, there are usually multiple work files corresponding to a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1155 single master file---often each user has his own copy. It is also
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1156 possible to use RCS in this way, but this is not the usual way to use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1157 RCS.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1158
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1159 @cindex locking and version control
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1160 A version control system typically has some mechanism to coordinate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1161 between users who want to change the same file. One method is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1162 @dfn{locking} (analogous to the locking that Emacs uses to detect
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1163 simultaneous editing of a file, but distinct from it). The other method
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1164 is to merge your changes with other people's changes when you check them
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1165 in.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1166
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1167 With version control locking, work files are normally read-only so
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1168 that you cannot change them. You ask the version control system to make
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1169 a work file writable for you by locking it; only one user can do
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1170 this at any given time. When you check in your changes, that unlocks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1171 the file, making the work file read-only again. This allows other users
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1172 to lock the file to make further changes. SCCS always uses locking, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1173 RCS normally does.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1174
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1175 The other alternative for RCS is to let each user modify the work file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1176 at any time. In this mode, locking is not required, but it is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1177 permitted; check-in is still the way to record a new version.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1178
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1179 CVS normally allows each user to modify his own copy of the work file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1180 at any time, but requires merging with changes from other users at
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1181 check-in time. However, CVS can also be set up to require locking.
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1182 (@pxref{CVS Options}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1183
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1184 @node VC Mode Line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1185 @subsection Version Control and the Mode Line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1186
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1187 When you visit a file that is under version control, Emacs indicates
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1188 this on the mode line. For example, @samp{RCS-1.3} says that RCS is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1189 used for that file, and the current version is 1.3.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1190
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1191 The character between the back-end name and the version number
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1192 indicates the version control status of the file. @samp{-} means that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1193 the work file is not locked (if locking is in use), or not modified (if
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1194 locking is not in use). @samp{:} indicates that the file is locked, or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1195 that it is modified. If the file is locked by some other user (for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1196 instance, @samp{jim}), that is displayed as @samp{RCS:jim:1.3}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1197
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1198 @node Basic VC Editing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1199 @subsection Basic Editing under Version Control
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1200
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1201 The principal VC command is an all-purpose command that performs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1202 either locking or check-in, depending on the situation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1203
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1204 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1205 @item C-x C-q
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1206 @itemx C-x v v
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1207 Perform the next logical version control operation on this file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1208 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1209
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1210 @findex vc-next-action
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1211 @findex vc-toggle-read-only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1212 @kindex C-x v v
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1213 @kindex C-x C-q @r{(Version Control)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1214 Strictly speaking, the command for this job is @code{vc-next-action},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1215 bound to @kbd{C-x v v}. However, the normal meaning of @kbd{C-x C-q} is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1216 to make a read-only buffer writable, or vice versa; we have extended it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1217 to do the same job properly for files managed by version control, by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1218 performing the appropriate version control operations. When you type
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1219 @kbd{C-x C-q} on a registered file, it acts like @kbd{C-x v v}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1220
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1221 The precise action of this command depends on the state of the file,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1222 and whether the version control system uses locking or not. SCCS and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1223 RCS normally use locking; CVS normally does not use locking.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1224
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1225 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1226 * VC with Locking:: RCS in its default mode, SCCS, and optionally CVS.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1227 * Without Locking:: Without locking: default mode for CVS.
36402
e06c9b1a0b04 (Advanced C-x C-q): Fix prev change.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36385
diff changeset
1228 * Advanced C-x C-q:: Advanced features available with a prefix argument.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1229 * Log Buffer:: Features available in log entry buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1230 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1231
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1232 @node VC with Locking
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1233 @subsubsection Basic Version Control with Locking
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1234
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1235 If locking is used for the file (as with SCCS, and RCS in its default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1236 mode), @kbd{C-x C-q} can either lock a file or check it in:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1237
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1238 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1239 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1240 If the file is not locked, @kbd{C-x C-q} locks it, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1241 makes it writable so that you can change it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1242
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1243 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1244 If the file is locked by you, and contains changes, @kbd{C-x C-q} checks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1245 in the changes. In order to do this, it first reads the log entry
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1246 for the new version. @xref{Log Buffer}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1247
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1248 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1249 If the file is locked by you, but you have not changed it since you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1250 locked it, @kbd{C-x C-q} releases the lock and makes the file read-only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1251 again.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1252
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1253 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1254 If the file is locked by some other user, @kbd{C-x C-q} asks you whether
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1255 you want to ``steal the lock'' from that user. If you say yes, the file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1256 becomes locked by you, but a message is sent to the person who had
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1257 formerly locked the file, to inform him of what has happened.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1258 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1259
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1260 These rules also apply when you use CVS in locking mode, except
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1261 that there is no such thing as stealing a lock.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1262
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1263 @node Without Locking
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1264 @subsubsection Basic Version Control without Locking
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1265
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1266 When there is no locking---the default for CVS---work files are always
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1267 writable; you do not need to do anything before you begin to edit a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1268 file. The status indicator on the mode line is @samp{-} if the file is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1269 unmodified; it flips to @samp{:} as soon as you save any changes in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1270 work file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1271
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1272 Here is what @kbd{C-x C-q} does when using CVS:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1273
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1274 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1275 @item
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1276 If some other user has checked in changes into the master file, Emacs
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1277 asks you whether you want to merge those changes into your own work
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1278 file. You must do this before you can check in your own changes. (To
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1279 pick up any recent changes from the master file @emph{without} trying
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1280 to commit your own changes, type @kbd{C-x v m @key{RET}}.)
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1281 @xref{Merging}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1282
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1283 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1284 If there are no new changes in the master file, but you have made
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1285 modifications in your work file, @kbd{C-x C-q} checks in your changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1286 In order to do this, it first reads the log entry for the new version.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1287 @xref{Log Buffer}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1288
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1289 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1290 If the file is not modified, the @kbd{C-x C-q} does nothing.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1291 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1292
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1293 These rules also apply when you use RCS in the mode that does not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1294 require locking, except that automatic merging of changes from the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1295 master file is not implemented. Unfortunately, this means that nothing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1296 informs you if another user has checked in changes in the same file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1297 since you began editing it, and when this happens, his changes will be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1298 effectively removed when you check in your version (though they will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1299 remain in the master file, so they will not be entirely lost). You must
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1300 therefore verify the current version is unchanged, before you check in your
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1301 changes. We hope to eliminate this risk and provide automatic merging
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1302 with RCS in a future Emacs version.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1303
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1304 In addition, locking is possible with RCS even in this mode, although
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1305 it is not required; @kbd{C-x C-q} with an unmodified file locks the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1306 file, just as it does with RCS in its normal (locking) mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1307
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1308 @node Advanced C-x C-q
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1309 @subsubsection Advanced Control in @kbd{C-x C-q}
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1310
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1311 When you give a prefix argument to @code{vc-next-action} (@kbd{C-u
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1312 C-x C-q}), it still performs the next logical version control
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1313 operation, but accepts additional arguments to specify precisely how
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1314 to do the operation.
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1315
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1316 @itemize @bullet
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1317 @item
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1318 If the file is modified (or locked), you can specify the version
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1319 number to use for the new verion that you check-in. This is one way
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1320 to create a new branch (@pxref{Branches}).
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1321
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1322 @item
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1323 If the file is not modified (and unlocked), you can specify the
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1324 version to select; this lets you start working from an older version,
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1325 or on another branch. If you do not enter any version, that takes you
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1326 to the highest version on the current branch; therefore @kbd{C-u C-x
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1327 C-q @key{RET}} is a convenient way to get the latest version of a file from
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1328 the repository.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1329
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1330 @item
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1331 Instead of the version number, you can also specify the name of a
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1332 version control system. This is useful when one file is being managed
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1333 with two version control systems at the same time file (@pxref{Local
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1334 Version Control}).
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1335 @end itemize
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1336
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1337 @node Log Buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1338 @subsubsection Features of the Log Entry Buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1339
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1340 When you check in changes, @kbd{C-x C-q} first reads a log entry. It
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1341 pops up a buffer called @samp{*VC-Log*} for you to enter the log entry.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1342 When you are finished, type @kbd{C-c C-c} in the @samp{*VC-Log*} buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1343 That is when check-in really happens.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1344
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1345 To abort check-in, just @strong{don't} type @kbd{C-c C-c} in that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1346 buffer. You can switch buffers and do other editing. As long as you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1347 don't try to check in another file, the entry you were editing remains
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1348 in the @samp{*VC-Log*} buffer, and you can go back to that buffer at any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1349 time to complete the check-in.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1350
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1351 If you change several source files for the same reason, it is often
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1352 convenient to specify the same log entry for many of the files. To do
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1353 this, use the history of previous log entries. The commands @kbd{M-n},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1354 @kbd{M-p}, @kbd{M-s} and @kbd{M-r} for doing this work just like the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1355 minibuffer history commands (except that these versions are used outside
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1356 the minibuffer).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1357
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1358 @vindex vc-log-mode-hook
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1359 Each time you check in a file, the log entry buffer is put into VC Log
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1360 mode, which involves running two hooks: @code{text-mode-hook} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1361 @code{vc-log-mode-hook}. @xref{Hooks}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1362
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1363 @node Old Versions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1364 @subsection Examining And Comparing Old Versions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1365
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1366 One of the convenient features of version control is the ability
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1367 to examine any version of a file, or compare two versions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1368
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1369 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1370 @item C-x v ~ @var{version} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1371 Examine version @var{version} of the visited file, in a buffer of its
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1372 own.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1373
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1374 @item C-x v =
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1375 Compare the current buffer contents with the latest checked-in version
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1376 of the file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1377
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1378 @item C-u C-x v = @var{file} @key{RET} @var{oldvers} @key{RET} @var{newvers} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1379 Compare the specified two versions of @var{file}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1380
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1381 @item C-x v g
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1382 Display the result of the CVS annotate command using colors.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1383 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1384
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1385 @findex vc-version-other-window
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1386 @kindex C-x v ~
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1387 To examine an old version in toto, visit the file and then type
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1388 @kbd{C-x v ~ @var{version} @key{RET}} (@code{vc-version-other-window}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1389 This puts the text of version @var{version} in a file named
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1390 @file{@var{filename}.~@var{version}~}, and visits it in its own buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1391 in a separate window. (In RCS, you can also select an old version
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1392 and create a branch from it. @xref{Branches}.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1393
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1394 @findex vc-diff
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1395 @kindex C-x v =
36323
7ecef0fc04b0 (Old versions): Fix "But usually is". From Nelson H. F. Beebe
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36322
diff changeset
1396 It is usually more convenient to compare two versions of the file,
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1397 with the command @kbd{C-x v =} (@code{vc-diff}). Plain @kbd{C-x v =}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1398 compares the current buffer contents (saving them in the file if
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1399 necessary) with the last checked-in version of the file. @kbd{C-u C-x
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1400 v =}, with a numeric argument, reads a file name and two version
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1401 numbers, then compares those versions of the specified file. Both
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1402 forms display the output in a special buffer in another window.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1403
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1404 You can specify a checked-in version by its number; an empty input
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1405 specifies the current contents of the work file (which may be different
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1406 from all the checked-in versions). You can also specify a snapshot name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1407 (@pxref{Snapshots}) instead of one or both version numbers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1408
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1409 If you supply a directory name instead of the name of a registered
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1410 file, this command compares the two specified versions of all registered
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1411 files in that directory and its subdirectories.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1412
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1413 @vindex diff-switches
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1414 @vindex vc-diff-switches
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1415 @kbd{C-x v =} works by running a variant of the @code{diff} utility
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1416 designed to work with the version control system in use. Emacs passes
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1417 the contents of the variable @code{diff-switches} to it; you can
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1418 specify comparison options for version control in
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1419 @code{vc-diff-switches}, and there are similar variables for each
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1420 specific system---@code{vc-rcs-diff-switches}, and so on.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1421
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1422 Unlike the @kbd{M-x diff} command, @kbd{C-x v =} does not try to
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1423 locate the changes in the old and new versions. This is because
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1424 normally one or both versions do not exist as files when you compare
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1425 them; they exist only in the records of the master file.
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1426 @xref{Comparing Files}, for more information about @kbd{M-x diff}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1427
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1428 @findex vc-annotate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1429 @kindex C-x v g
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1430 For CVS-controlled files, you can display the result of the CVS
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1431 annotate command, using colors to enhance the visual appearance. Use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1432 the command @kbd{M-x vc-annotate} to do this. Red means new, blue means
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1433 old, and intermediate colors indicate intermediate ages. A prefix
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1434 argument @var{n} specifies a stretch factor for the time scale; it makes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1435 each color cover a period @var{n} times as long.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1436
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1437 @node Secondary VC Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1438 @subsection The Secondary Commands of VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1439
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1440 This section explains the secondary commands of VC; those that you might
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1441 use once a day.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1442
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1443 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1444 * Registering:: Putting a file under version control.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1445 * VC Status:: Viewing the VC status of files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1446 * VC Undo:: Cancelling changes before or after check-in.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1447 * VC Dired Mode:: Listing files managed by version control.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1448 * VC Dired Commands:: Commands to use in a VC Dired buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1449 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1450
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1451 @node Registering
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1452 @subsubsection Registering a File for Version Control
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1453
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1454 @kindex C-x v i
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1455 @findex vc-register
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1456 You can put any file under version control by simply visiting it, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1457 then typing @w{@kbd{C-x v i}} (@code{vc-register}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1458
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1459 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1460 @item C-x v i
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1461 Register the visited file for version control.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1462 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1463
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1464 To register the file, Emacs must choose which version control system
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1465 to use for it. If the file's directory already contains files
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1466 registered in a version control system, Emacs uses that system. If
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1467 there is more than one system in use for a directory, Emacs uses the one
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1468 that appears first in @var{vc-handled-backends} (@pxref{Customizing VC}).
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1469 On the other hand, if there are no files already registered,
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1470 Emacs uses the first system from @var{vc-handled-backends} that could
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1471 register the file---for example, you cannot register a file under CVS if
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1472 its directory is not already part of a CVS tree.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1473
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1474 With the default value of @var{vc-handled-backends}, this means that
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1475 Emacs uses RCS if there are any files under RCS control, or CVS if
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1476 there are any files under CVS, or RCS as the ultimate default.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1477
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1478 If locking is in use, @kbd{C-x v i} leaves the file unlocked and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1479 read-only. Type @kbd{C-x C-q} if you wish to start editing it. After
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1480 registering a file with CVS, you must subsequently commit the initial
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1481 version by typing @kbd{C-x C-q}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1482
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1483 @vindex vc-default-init-version
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1484 The initial version number for a newly registered file is 1.1, by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1485 default. You can specify a different default by setting the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1486 @code{vc-default-init-version}, or you can give @kbd{C-x v i} a numeric
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1487 argument; then it reads the initial version number for this particular
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1488 file using the minibuffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1489
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1490 @vindex vc-initial-comment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1491 If @code{vc-initial-comment} is non-@code{nil}, @kbd{C-x v i} reads an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1492 initial comment to describe the purpose of this source file. Reading
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1493 the initial comment works like reading a log entry (@pxref{Log Buffer}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1494
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1495 @node VC Status
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1496 @subsubsection VC Status Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1497
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1498 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1499 @item C-x v l
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1500 Display version control state and change history.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1501 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1502
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1503 @kindex C-x v l
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1504 @findex vc-print-log
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1505 To view the detailed version control status and history of a file,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1506 type @kbd{C-x v l} (@code{vc-print-log}). It displays the history of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1507 changes to the current file, including the text of the log entries. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1508 output appears in a separate window.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1509
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1510 @node VC Undo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1511 @subsubsection Undoing Version Control Actions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1512
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1513 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1514 @item C-x v u
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1515 Revert the buffer and the file to the last checked-in version.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1516
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1517 @item C-x v c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1518 Remove the last-entered change from the master for the visited file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1519 This undoes your last check-in.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1520 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1521
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1522 @kindex C-x v u
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1523 @findex vc-revert-buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1524 If you want to discard your current set of changes and revert to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1525 last version checked in, use @kbd{C-x v u} (@code{vc-revert-buffer}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1526 This leaves the file unlocked; if locking is in use, you must first lock
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1527 the file again before you change it again. @kbd{C-x v u} requires
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1528 confirmation, unless it sees that you haven't made any changes since the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1529 last checked-in version.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1530
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1531 @kbd{C-x v u} is also the command to unlock a file if you lock it and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1532 then decide not to change it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1533
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1534 @kindex C-x v c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1535 @findex vc-cancel-version
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1536 To cancel a change that you already checked in, use @kbd{C-x v c}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1537 (@code{vc-cancel-version}). This command discards all record of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1538 most recent checked-in version. @kbd{C-x v c} also offers to revert
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1539 your work file and buffer to the previous version (the one that precedes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1540 the version that is deleted).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1541
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1542 If you answer @kbd{no}, VC keeps your changes in the buffer, and locks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1543 the file. The no-revert option is useful when you have checked in a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1544 change and then discover a trivial error in it; you can cancel the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1545 erroneous check-in, fix the error, and check the file in again.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1546
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1547 When @kbd{C-x v c} does not revert the buffer, it unexpands all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1548 version control headers in the buffer instead (@pxref{Version Headers}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1549 This is because the buffer no longer corresponds to any existing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1550 version. If you check it in again, the check-in process will expand the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1551 headers properly for the new version number.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1552
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1553 However, it is impossible to unexpand the RCS @samp{@w{$}Log$} header
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1554 automatically. If you use that header feature, you have to unexpand it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1555 by hand---by deleting the entry for the version that you just canceled.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1556
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1557 Be careful when invoking @kbd{C-x v c}, as it is easy to lose a lot of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1558 work with it. To help you be careful, this command always requires
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1559 confirmation with @kbd{yes}. Note also that this command is disabled
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1560 under CVS, because canceling versions is very dangerous and discouraged
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1561 with CVS.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1562
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1563 @node VC Dired Mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1564 @subsubsection Dired under VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1565
31076
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
1566 @cindex PCL-CVS
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
1567 @pindex cvs
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
1568 @cindex CVS Dired Mode
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1569 The VC Dired Mode described here works with all the version control
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1570 systems that VC supports. Another more powerful facility, designed
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1571 specifically for CVS, is called PCL-CVS. @xref{Top, , About PCL-CVS,
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
1572 pcl-cvs, PCL-CVS --- The Emacs Front-End to CVS}.
31076
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
1573
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1574 @kindex C-x v d
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1575 @findex vc-directory
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1576 When you are working on a large program, it is often useful to find
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1577 out which files have changed within an entire directory tree, or to view
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1578 the status of all files under version control at once, and to perform
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1579 version control operations on collections of files. You can use the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1580 command @kbd{C-x v d} (@code{vc-directory}) to make a directory listing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1581 that includes only files relevant for version control.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1582
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1583 @vindex vc-dired-terse-display
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1584 @kbd{C-x v d} creates a buffer which uses VC Dired Mode. This looks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1585 much like an ordinary Dired buffer (@pxref{Dired}); however, normally it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1586 shows only the noteworthy files (those locked or not up-to-date). This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1587 is called @dfn{terse display}. If you set the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1588 @code{vc-dired-terse-display} to @code{nil}, then VC Dired shows all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1589 relevant files---those managed under version control, plus all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1590 subdirectories (@dfn{full display}). The command @kbd{v t} in a VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1591 Dired buffer toggles between terse display and full display (@pxref{VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1592 Dired Commands}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1593
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1594 @vindex vc-dired-recurse
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1595 By default, VC Dired produces a recursive listing of noteworthy or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1596 relevant files at or below the given directory. You can change this by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1597 setting the variable @code{vc-dired-recurse} to @code{nil}; then VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1598 Dired shows only the files in the given directory.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1599
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1600 The line for an individual file shows the version control state in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1601 place of the hard link count, owner, group, and size of the file. If
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1602 the file is unmodified, in sync with the master file, the version
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1603 control state shown is blank. Otherwise it consists of text in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1604 parentheses. Under RCS and SCCS, the name of the user locking the file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1605 is shown; under CVS, an abbreviated version of the @samp{cvs status}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1606 output is used. Here is an example using RCS:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1607
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1608 @smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1609 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1610 /home/jim/project:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1611
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1612 -rw-r--r-- (jim) Apr 2 23:39 file1
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1613 -r--r--r-- Apr 5 20:21 file2
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1614 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1615 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1616
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1617 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1618 The files @samp{file1} and @samp{file2} are under version control,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1619 @samp{file1} is locked by user jim, and @samp{file2} is unlocked.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1620
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1621 Here is an example using CVS:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1622
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1623 @smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1624 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1625 /home/joe/develop:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1626
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1627 -rw-r--r-- (modified) Aug 2 1997 file1.c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1628 -rw-r--r-- Apr 4 20:09 file2.c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1629 -rw-r--r-- (merge) Sep 13 1996 file3.c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1630 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1631 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1632
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1633 Here @samp{file1.c} is modified with respect to the repository, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1634 @samp{file2.c} is not. @samp{file3.c} is modified, but other changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1635 have also been checked in to the repository---you need to merge them
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1636 with the work file before you can check it in.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1637
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1638 @vindex vc-directory-exclusion-list
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1639 When VC Dired displays subdirectories (in the ``full'' display mode),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1640 it omits some that should never contain any files under version control.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1641 By default, this includes Version Control subdirectories such as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1642 @samp{RCS} and @samp{CVS}; you can customize this by setting the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1643 variable @code{vc-directory-exclusion-list}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1644
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1645 You can fine-tune VC Dired's format by typing @kbd{C-u C-x v d}---as in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1646 ordinary Dired, that allows you to specify additional switches for the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1647 @samp{ls} command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1648
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1649 @node VC Dired Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1650 @subsubsection VC Dired Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1651
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1652 All the usual Dired commands work normally in VC Dired mode, except
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1653 for @kbd{v}, which is redefined as the version control prefix. You can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1654 invoke VC commands such as @code{vc-diff} and @code{vc-print-log} by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1655 typing @kbd{v =}, or @kbd{v l}, and so on. Most of these commands apply
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1656 to the file name on the current line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1657
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1658 The command @kbd{v v} (@code{vc-next-action}) operates on all the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1659 marked files, so that you can lock or check in several files at once.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1660 If it operates on more than one file, it handles each file according to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1661 its current state; thus, it might lock one file, but check in another
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1662 file. This could be confusing; it is up to you to avoid confusing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1663 behavior by marking a set of files that are in a similar state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1664
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1665 If any files call for check-in, @kbd{v v} reads a single log entry,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1666 then uses it for all the files being checked in. This is convenient for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1667 registering or checking in several files at once, as part of the same
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1668 change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1669
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1670 @findex vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1671 @findex vc-dired-mark-locked
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1672 You can toggle between terse display (only locked files, or files not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1673 up-to-date) and full display at any time by typing @kbd{v t}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1674 @code{vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode}. There is also a special command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1675 @kbd{* l} (@code{vc-dired-mark-locked}), which marks all files currently
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1676 locked (or, with CVS, all files not up-to-date). Thus, typing @kbd{* l
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1677 t k} is another way to delete from the buffer all files except those
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1678 currently locked.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1679
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1680 @node Branches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1681 @subsection Multiple Branches of a File
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1682 @cindex branch (version control)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1683 @cindex trunk (version control)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1684
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1685 One use of version control is to maintain multiple ``current''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1686 versions of a file. For example, you might have different versions of a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1687 program in which you are gradually adding various unfinished new
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1688 features. Each such independent line of development is called a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1689 @dfn{branch}. VC allows you to create branches, switch between
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1690 different branches, and merge changes from one branch to another.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1691 Please note, however, that branches are only supported for RCS at the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1692 moment.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1693
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1694 A file's main line of development is usually called the @dfn{trunk}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1695 The versions on the trunk are normally numbered 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, etc. At
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1696 any such version, you can start an independent branch. A branch
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1697 starting at version 1.2 would have version number 1.2.1.1, and consecutive
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1698 versions on this branch would have numbers 1.2.1.2, 1.2.1.3, 1.2.1.4,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1699 and so on. If there is a second branch also starting at version 1.2, it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1700 would consist of versions 1.2.2.1, 1.2.2.2, 1.2.2.3, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1701
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1702 @cindex head version
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1703 If you omit the final component of a version number, that is called a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1704 @dfn{branch number}. It refers to the highest existing version on that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1705 branch---the @dfn{head version} of that branch. The branches in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1706 example above have branch numbers 1.2.1 and 1.2.2.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1707
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1708 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1709 * Switching Branches:: How to get to another existing branch.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1710 * Creating Branches:: How to start a new branch.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1711 * Merging:: Transferring changes between branches.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1712 * Multi-User Branching:: Multiple users working at multiple branches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1713 in parallel.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1714 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1715
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1716 @node Switching Branches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1717 @subsubsection Switching between Branches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1718
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1719 To switch between branches, type @kbd{C-u C-x C-q} and specify the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1720 version number you want to select. This version is then visited
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1721 @emph{unlocked} (write-protected), so you can examine it before locking
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1722 it. Switching branches in this way is allowed only when the file is not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1723 locked.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1724
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1725 You can omit the minor version number, thus giving only the branch
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1726 number; this takes you to the head version on the chosen branch. If you
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1727 only type @key{RET}, Emacs goes to the highest version on the trunk.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1728
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1729 After you have switched to any branch (including the main branch), you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1730 stay on it for subsequent VC commands, until you explicitly select some
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1731 other branch.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1732
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1733 @node Creating Branches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1734 @subsubsection Creating New Branches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1735
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1736 To create a new branch from a head version (one that is the latest in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1737 the branch that contains it), first select that version if necessary,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1738 lock it with @kbd{C-x C-q}, and make whatever changes you want. Then,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1739 when you check in the changes, use @kbd{C-u C-x C-q}. This lets you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1740 specify the version number for the new version. You should specify a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1741 suitable branch number for a branch starting at the current version.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1742 For example, if the current version is 2.5, the branch number should be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1743 2.5.1, 2.5.2, and so on, depending on the number of existing branches at
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1744 that point.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1745
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1746 To create a new branch at an older version (one that is no longer the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1747 head of a branch), first select that version (@pxref{Switching
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1748 Branches}), then lock it with @kbd{C-x C-q}. You'll be asked to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1749 confirm, when you lock the old version, that you really mean to create a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1750 new branch---if you say no, you'll be offered a chance to lock the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1751 latest version instead.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1752
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1753 Then make your changes and type @kbd{C-x C-q} again to check in a new
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1754 version. This automatically creates a new branch starting from the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1755 selected version. You need not specially request a new branch, because
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1756 that's the only way to add a new version at a point that is not the head
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1757 of a branch.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1758
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1759 After the branch is created, you ``stay'' on it. That means that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1760 subsequent check-ins create new versions on that branch. To leave the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1761 branch, you must explicitly select a different version with @kbd{C-u C-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1762 C-q}. To transfer changes from one branch to another, use the merge
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1763 command, described in the next section.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1764
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1765 @node Merging
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1766 @subsubsection Merging Branches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1767
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1768 @cindex merging changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1769 When you have finished the changes on a certain branch, you will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1770 often want to incorporate them into the file's main line of development
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1771 (the trunk). This is not a trivial operation, because development might
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1772 also have proceeded on the trunk, so that you must @dfn{merge} the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1773 changes into a file that has already been changed otherwise. VC allows
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1774 you to do this (and other things) with the @code{vc-merge} command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1775
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1776 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1777 @item C-x v m (vc-merge)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1778 Merge changes into the work file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1779 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1780
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1781 @kindex C-x v m
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1782 @findex vc-merge
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1783 @kbd{C-x v m} (@code{vc-merge}) takes a set of changes and merges it
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1784 into the current version of the work file. It firsts asks you in the
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1785 minibuffer where the changes should come from. If you just type
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1786 @key{RET}, Emacs merges any changes that were made on the same branch
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1787 since you checked the file out (we call this @dfn{merging the news}).
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1788 This is the common way to pick up recent changes from the repository,
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1789 regardless of whether you have already changed the file yourself.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1790
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1791 You can also enter a branch number or a pair of version numbers in
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1792 the minibuffer. Then it finds the changes from that branch, or between
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1793 the two versions you specified, and merges them into the current version
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1794 of the current file.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1795
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1796 As an example, suppose that you have finished a certain feature on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1797 branch 1.3.1. In the meantime, development on the trunk has proceeded
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1798 to version 1.5. To merge the changes from the branch to the trunk,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1799 first go to the head version of the trunk, by typing @kbd{C-u C-x C-q
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1800 @key{RET}}. Version 1.5 is now current. If locking is used for the file,
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1801 type @kbd{C-x C-q} to lock version 1.5 so that you can change it. Next,
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1802 type @kbd{C-x v m 1.3.1 @key{RET}}. This takes the entire set of changes on
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1803 branch 1.3.1 (relative to version 1.3, where the branch started, up to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1804 the last version on the branch) and merges it into the current version
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1805 of the work file. You can now check in the changed file, thus creating
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1806 version 1.6 containing the changes from the branch.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1807
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1808 It is possible to do further editing after merging the branch, before
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1809 the next check-in. But it is usually wiser to check in the merged
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1810 version, then lock it and make the further changes. This will keep
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1811 a better record of the history of changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1812
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1813 @cindex conflicts
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1814 @cindex resolving conflicts
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1815 When you merge changes into a file that has itself been modified, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1816 changes might overlap. We call this situation a @dfn{conflict}, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1817 reconciling the conflicting changes is called @dfn{resolving a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1818 conflict}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1819
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1820 Whenever conflicts occur during merging, VC detects them, tells you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1821 about them in the echo area, and asks whether you want help in merging.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1822 If you say yes, it starts an Ediff session (@pxref{Top,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1823 Ediff, Ediff, ediff, The Ediff Manual}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1824
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1825 If you say no, the conflicting changes are both inserted into the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1826 file, surrounded by @dfn{conflict markers}. The example below shows how
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1827 a conflict region looks; the file is called @samp{name} and the current
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1828 master file version with user B's changes in it is 1.11.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1830 @c @w here is so CVS won't think this is a conflict.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1831 @smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1832 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1833 @w{<}<<<<<< name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1834 @var{User A's version}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1835 =======
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1836 @var{User B's version}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1837 @w{>}>>>>>> 1.11
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1838 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1839 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1840
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1841 @cindex vc-resolve-conflicts
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1842 Then you can resolve the conflicts by editing the file manually. Or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1843 you can type @code{M-x vc-resolve-conflicts} after visiting the file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1844 This starts an Ediff session, as described above.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1845
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1846 @node Multi-User Branching
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1847 @subsubsection Multi-User Branching
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1848
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1849 It is often useful for multiple developers to work simultaneously on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1850 different branches of a file. CVS allows this by default; for RCS, it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1851 is possible if you create multiple source directories. Each source
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1852 directory should have a link named @file{RCS} which points to a common
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1853 directory of RCS master files. Then each source directory can have its
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1854 own choice of selected versions, but all share the same common RCS
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1855 records.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1856
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1857 This technique works reliably and automatically, provided that the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1858 source files contain RCS version headers (@pxref{Version Headers}). The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1859 headers enable Emacs to be sure, at all times, which version number is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1860 present in the work file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1861
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1862 If the files do not have version headers, you must instead tell Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1863 explicitly in each session which branch you are working on. To do this,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1864 first find the file, then type @kbd{C-u C-x C-q} and specify the correct
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1865 branch number. This ensures that Emacs knows which branch it is using
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1866 during this particular editing session.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1867
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1868 @node Remote Repositories
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1869 @subsection Remote Repositories
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1870 @cindex remote repositories (CVS)
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1871
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1872 A common way of using CVS is to set up a central CVS repository on
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1873 some Internet host, then have each developer check out a personal
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1874 working copy of the files on his local machine. Committing changes to
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1875 the repository, and picking up changes from other users into one's own
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1876 working area, then works by direct interactions with the CVS server.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1877
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1878 One difficulty is that access to the CVS server is often slow, and
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1879 that developers might need to work offline as well. VC is designed
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1880 to reduce the amount of network interaction necessary.
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1881
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1882 @menu
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1883 * Version Backups:: Keeping local copies of repository versions.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1884 * Local Version Control:: Using another version system for local editing.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1885 @end menu
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1886
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1887 @node Version Backups
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1888 @subsubsection Version Backups
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1889 @cindex version backups
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1890
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1891 @cindex automatic version backups
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1892 When VC sees that the CVS repository for a file is on a remote
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1893 machine, it automatically makes local backups of unmodified versions
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1894 of the file---@dfn{automatic version backups}. This means that you
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1895 can compare the file to the repository version (@kbd{C-x v =}), or
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1896 revert to that version (@kbd{C-x v u}), without any network
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1897 interactions.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1898
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1899 The local copy of the unmodified file is called a @dfn{version
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1900 backup} to indicate that it corresponds exactly to a version that is
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1901 stored in the repository. Note that version backups are not the same
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1902 as ordinary Emacs backup files (@pxref{Backup}). But they follow a
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1903 similar naming convention.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1904
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1905 For a file that comes from a remote CVS repository, VC makes a
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1906 version backup whenever you save the first changes to the file, and
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1907 removes it after you have committed your modified version to the
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1908 repository. You can disable the making of automatic version backups by
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1909 setting @code{vc-cvs-stay-local} to @code{nil} (@pxref{CVS Options}).
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1910
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1911 @cindex manual version backups
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1912 The name of the automatic version backup for version @var{version}
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1913 of file @var{file} is @code{@var{file}.~@var{version}.~}. This is
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1914 almost the same as the name used by @kbd{C-x v ~} (@pxref{Old
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1915 Versions}), the only difference being the additional dot (@samp{.})
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1916 after the version number. This similarity is intentional, because
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1917 both kinds of files store the same kind of information. The file made
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1918 by @kbd{C-x v ~} acts as a @dfn{manual version backup}.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1919
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1920 All the VC commands that operate on old versions of a file can use
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1921 both kinds of version backups. For instance, @kbd{C-x v ~} uses
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1922 either an automatic or a manual version backup, if possible, to get
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1923 the contents of the version you request. Likewise, @kbd{C-x v =} and
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1924 @kbd{C-x v u} use either an automatic or a manual version backup, if
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1925 one of them exists, to get the contents of a version to compare or
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1926 revert to. If you changed a file outside of Emacs, so that no
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1927 automatic version backup was created for the previous text, you can
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1928 create a manual backup of that version using @kbd{C-x v ~}, and thus
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1929 obtain the benefit of the local copy for Emacs commands.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1930
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1931 The only difference in Emacs's handling of manual and automatic
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1932 version backups, once they exist, is that Emacs deletes automatic
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1933 version backups when you commit to the repository. By contrast,
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1934 manual version backups remain until you delete them.
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1935
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1936 @node Local Version Control
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1937 @subsubsection Local Version Control
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1938 @cindex local version control
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1939 @cindex local back end (version control)
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1940
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1941 When you make many changes to a file that comes from a remote
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1942 repository, it can be convenient to have version control on your local
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1943 machine as well. You can then record intermediate versions, revert to
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1944 a previous state, etc., before you actually commit your changes to the
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1945 remote server.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1946
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1947 VC lets you do this by putting a file under a second, local version
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1948 control system, so that the file is effectively registered in two
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1949 systems at the same time. For the description here, we will assume
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1950 that the remote system is CVS, and you use RCS locally, although the
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1951 mechanism works with any combination of version control systems
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1952 (@dfn{back ends}).
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1953
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1954 To make it work with other back ends, you must make sure that the
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1955 ``more local'' back end comes before the ``more remote'' back end in
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1956 the setting of @var{vc-handled-backends} (@pxref{Customizing VC}). By
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1957 default, this variable is set up so that you can use remote CVS and
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1958 local RCS as described here.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1959
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1960 To start using local RCS for a file that comes from a remote CVS
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1961 server, you must @emph{register the file in RCS}, by typing @kbd{C-u
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1962 C-x v v rcs @key{RET}}. (In other words, use @code{vc-next-action} with a
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1963 prefix argument, and specify RCS as the back end.)
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1964
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1965 You can do this at any time; it does not matter whether you have
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1966 already modified the file with respect to the version in the CVS
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1967 repository. If possible, VC tries to make the RCS master start with
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1968 the unmodified repository version, then checking in any local changes
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1969 as a new version. This works if you have not made any changes yet, or
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1970 if the unmodified repository version exists locally as a version
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1971 backup (@pxref{Version Backups}). If the unmodified version is not
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1972 available locally, the RCS master starts with the modified version;
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1973 the only drawback of this is that you cannot compare your changes
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1974 locally to what is stored in the repository.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1975
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1976 The version number of the RCS master is derived from the current CVS
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1977 version, starting a branch from it. For example, if the current CVS
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1978 version is 1.23, the local RCS branch will be 1.23.1. Version 1.23 in
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1979 the RCS master will be identical to version 1.23 under CVS; your first
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1980 changes are checked in as 1.23.1.1. (If the unmodified file is not
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1981 available locally, VC will check in the modified file twice, both as
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1982 1.23 and 1.23.1.1, to make the revision numbers consistent.)
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1983
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1984 If you do not use locking under CVS (the default), locking is also
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1985 disabled for RCS, so that editing under RCS works exactly as under
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1986 CVS.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1987
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1988 When you are done with your edits, you can commit the final version
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1989 back to the CVS repository, typing @kbd{C-u C-x v v cvs @key{RET}}. Emacs
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1990 will initialize the log entry buffer (@pxref{Log Buffer}) to contain
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1991 all the log entries you have recorded in the RCS master; you can make
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1992 changes to these comments as needed, and then commit in CVS by typing
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1993 @kbd{C-c C-c}. If the commit is successful, VC removes the RCS
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1994 master, so that the file is once again registered under CVS only.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1995 (The RCS master is not actually deleted, just renamed by appending
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1996 @samp{~} to the name, so that you can refer to it later if you wish.)
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1997
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
1998 While you are working with a local RCS master, you may still want to
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
1999 pick up recent changes from the CVS repository into your local file,
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2000 or you might want to commit some of your changes back to CVS, without
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2001 actually switching back to CVS completely. You can do this by
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2002 switching to another backend temporarily.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2003
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2004 @table @kbd
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2005 @item C-x v b
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2006 Switch to another back end that the current file is registered
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2007 under (@code{vc-switch-backend}).
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2008
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2009 @item C-u C-x v b @var{backend} @key{RET}
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2010 Switch to @var{backend} for the current file.
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2011 @end table
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2012
36360
0774daebf700 (Local Version Control): Fix last change.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36356
diff changeset
2013 @kindex C-x v b
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2014 @findex vc-switch-backend
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2015 @kbd{C-x v b} does not change the buffer contents, or any files; it
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2016 only changes VC's perspective on how to handle the file. Any
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2017 subsequent VC commands for that file will operate on the back end that
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2018 is currently selected.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2019
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2020 If the current file is registered in more than one back end, typing
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2021 @kbd{C-x v b} ``cycles'' through all of these back ends. With a
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2022 prefix argument, it asks for the back end to use in the minibuffer.
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2023
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2024 Thus, if you have a file under local RCS, and you want to pick up some
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2025 recent changes from CVS, type @kbd{C-x v b} to switch to CVS, and then
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2026 @kbd{C-x v m @key{RET}} to merge the news (@pxref{Merging}). You can
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2027 then switch back to RCS by typing @kbd{C-x v b} again, and continue to
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2028 edit locally.
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2029
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2030 Note though, that if you do this, the revision numbers in the RCS
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2031 master no longer correspond to those of CVS in a meaningful way.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2032 Technically, this is not a problem, but it might be more difficult for
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2033 you to keep track of what is in the repository and what is not. So we
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2034 suggest that, frequently, you commit your changes back to CVS
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2035 completely using @kbd{C-u C-x v v cvs @key{RET}}.
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2036
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2037 @node Snapshots
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2038 @subsection Snapshots
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2039 @cindex snapshots and version control
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2040
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2041 A @dfn{snapshot} is a named set of file versions (one for each
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2042 registered file) that you can treat as a unit. One important kind of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2043 snapshot is a @dfn{release}, a (theoretically) stable version of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2044 system that is ready for distribution to users.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2045
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2046 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2047 * Making Snapshots:: The snapshot facilities.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2048 * Snapshot Caveats:: Things to be careful of when using snapshots.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2049 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2050
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2051 @node Making Snapshots
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2052 @subsubsection Making and Using Snapshots
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2053
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2054 There are two basic commands for snapshots; one makes a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2055 snapshot with a given name, the other retrieves a named snapshot.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2056
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2057 @table @code
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2058 @kindex C-x v s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2059 @findex vc-create-snapshot
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2060 @item C-x v s @var{name} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2061 Define the last saved versions of every registered file in or under the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2062 current directory as a snapshot named @var{name}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2063 (@code{vc-create-snapshot}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2064
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2065 @kindex C-x v r
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2066 @findex vc-retrieve-snapshot
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2067 @item C-x v r @var{name} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2068 For all registered files at or below the current directory level, select
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2069 whatever versions correspond to the snapshot @var{name}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2070 (@code{vc-retrieve-snapshot}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2071
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2072 This command reports an error if any files are locked at or below the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2073 current directory, without changing anything; this is to avoid
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2074 overwriting work in progress.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2075 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2076
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2077 A snapshot uses a very small amount of resources---just enough to record
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2078 the list of file names and which version belongs to the snapshot. Thus,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2079 you need not hesitate to create snapshots whenever they are useful.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2080
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2081 You can give a snapshot name as an argument to @kbd{C-x v =} or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2082 @kbd{C-x v ~} (@pxref{Old Versions}). Thus, you can use it to compare a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2083 snapshot against the current files, or two snapshots against each other,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2084 or a snapshot against a named version.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2085
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2086 @node Snapshot Caveats
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2087 @subsubsection Snapshot Caveats
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2088
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2089 @cindex named configurations (RCS)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2090 VC's snapshot facilities are modeled on RCS's named-configuration
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2091 support. They use RCS's native facilities for this, so under VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2092 snapshots made using RCS are visible even when you bypass VC.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2093
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2094 @c worded verbosely to avoid overfull hbox.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2095 For SCCS, VC implements snapshots itself. The files it uses contain
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2096 name/file/version-number triples. These snapshots are visible only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2097 through VC.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2098
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2099 A snapshot is a set of checked-in versions. So make sure that all the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2100 files are checked in and not locked when you make a snapshot.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2101
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2102 File renaming and deletion can create some difficulties with snapshots.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2103 This is not a VC-specific problem, but a general design issue in version
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2104 control systems that no one has solved very well yet.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2105
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2106 If you rename a registered file, you need to rename its master along
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2107 with it (the command @code{vc-rename-file} does this automatically). If
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2108 you are using SCCS, you must also update the records of the snapshot, to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2109 mention the file by its new name (@code{vc-rename-file} does this,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2110 too). An old snapshot that refers to a master file that no longer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2111 exists under the recorded name is invalid; VC can no longer retrieve
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2112 it. It would be beyond the scope of this manual to explain enough about
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2113 RCS and SCCS to explain how to update the snapshots by hand.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2114
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2115 Using @code{vc-rename-file} makes the snapshot remain valid for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2116 retrieval, but it does not solve all problems. For example, some of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2117 files in the program probably refer to others by name. At the very
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2118 least, the makefile probably mentions the file that you renamed. If you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2119 retrieve an old snapshot, the renamed file is retrieved under its new
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2120 name, which is not the name that the makefile expects. So the program
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2121 won't really work as retrieved.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2122
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2123 @node Miscellaneous VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2124 @subsection Miscellaneous Commands and Features of VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2125
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2126 This section explains the less-frequently-used features of VC.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2127
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2128 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2129 * Change Logs and VC:: Generating a change log file from log entries.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2130 * Renaming and VC:: A command to rename both the source and master
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2131 file correctly.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2132 * Version Headers:: Inserting version control headers into working files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2133 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2134
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2135 @node Change Logs and VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2136 @subsubsection Change Logs and VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2137
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2138 If you use RCS or CVS for a program and also maintain a change log
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2139 file for it (@pxref{Change Log}), you can generate change log entries
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2140 automatically from the version control log entries:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2141
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2142 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2143 @item C-x v a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2144 @kindex C-x v a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2145 @findex vc-update-change-log
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2146 Visit the current directory's change log file and, for registered files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2147 in that directory, create new entries for versions checked in since the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2148 most recent entry in the change log file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2149 (@code{vc-update-change-log}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2150
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2151 This command works with RCS or CVS only, not with SCCS.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2152
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2153 @item C-u C-x v a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2154 As above, but only find entries for the current buffer's file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2155
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2156 @item M-1 C-x v a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2157 As above, but find entries for all the currently visited files that are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2158 maintained with version control. This works only with RCS, and it puts
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2159 all entries in the log for the default directory, which may not be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2160 appropriate.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2161 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2162
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2163 For example, suppose the first line of @file{ChangeLog} is dated
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2164 1999-04-10, and that the only check-in since then was by Nathaniel
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2165 Bowditch to @file{rcs2log} on 1999-05-22 with log text @samp{Ignore log
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2166 messages that start with `#'.}. Then @kbd{C-x v a} visits
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2167 @file{ChangeLog} and inserts text like this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2168
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2169 @iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2170 @medbreak
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2171 @end iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2172 @smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2173 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2174 1999-05-22 Nathaniel Bowditch <nat@@apn.org>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2175
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2176 * rcs2log: Ignore log messages that start with `#'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2177 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2178 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2179 @iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2180 @medbreak
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2181 @end iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2182
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2183 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2184 You can then edit the new change log entry further as you wish.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2185
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2186 Some of the new change log entry may duplicate what's already in
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2187 ChangeLog. You will have to remove these duplicates by hand.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2188
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2189 Normally, the log entry for file @file{foo} is displayed as @samp{*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2190 foo: @var{text of log entry}}. The @samp{:} after @file{foo} is omitted
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2191 if the text of the log entry starts with @w{@samp{(@var{functionname}):
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2192 }}. For example, if the log entry for @file{vc.el} is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2193 @samp{(vc-do-command): Check call-process status.}, then the text in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2194 @file{ChangeLog} looks like this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2195
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2196 @iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2197 @medbreak
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2198 @end iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2199 @smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2200 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2201 1999-05-06 Nathaniel Bowditch <nat@@apn.org>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2202
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2203 * vc.el (vc-do-command): Check call-process status.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2204 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2205 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2206 @iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2207 @medbreak
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2208 @end iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2209
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2210 When @kbd{C-x v a} adds several change log entries at once, it groups
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2211 related log entries together if they all are checked in by the same
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2212 author at nearly the same time. If the log entries for several such
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2213 files all have the same text, it coalesces them into a single entry.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2214 For example, suppose the most recent check-ins have the following log
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2215 entries:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2216
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2217 @flushleft
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2218 @bullet{} For @file{vc.texinfo}: @samp{Fix expansion typos.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2219 @bullet{} For @file{vc.el}: @samp{Don't call expand-file-name.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2220 @bullet{} For @file{vc-hooks.el}: @samp{Don't call expand-file-name.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2221 @end flushleft
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2222
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2223 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2224 They appear like this in @file{ChangeLog}:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2225
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2226 @iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2227 @medbreak
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2228 @end iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2229 @smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2230 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2231 1999-04-01 Nathaniel Bowditch <nat@@apn.org>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2232
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2233 * vc.texinfo: Fix expansion typos.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2234
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2235 * vc.el, vc-hooks.el: Don't call expand-file-name.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2236 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2237 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2238 @iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2239 @medbreak
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2240 @end iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2241
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2242 Normally, @kbd{C-x v a} separates log entries by a blank line, but you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2243 can mark several related log entries to be clumped together (without an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2244 intervening blank line) by starting the text of each related log entry
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2245 with a label of the form @w{@samp{@{@var{clumpname}@} }}. The label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2246 itself is not copied to @file{ChangeLog}. For example, suppose the log
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2247 entries are:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2248
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2249 @flushleft
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2250 @bullet{} For @file{vc.texinfo}: @samp{@{expand@} Fix expansion typos.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2251 @bullet{} For @file{vc.el}: @samp{@{expand@} Don't call expand-file-name.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2252 @bullet{} For @file{vc-hooks.el}: @samp{@{expand@} Don't call expand-file-name.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2253 @end flushleft
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2254
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2255 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2256 Then the text in @file{ChangeLog} looks like this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2257
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2258 @iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2259 @medbreak
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2260 @end iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2261 @smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2262 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2263 1999-04-01 Nathaniel Bowditch <nat@@apn.org>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2264
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2265 * vc.texinfo: Fix expansion typos.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2266 * vc.el, vc-hooks.el: Don't call expand-file-name.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2267 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2268 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2269 @iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2270 @medbreak
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2271 @end iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2272
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2273 A log entry whose text begins with @samp{#} is not copied to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2274 @file{ChangeLog}. For example, if you merely fix some misspellings in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2275 comments, you can log the change with an entry beginning with @samp{#}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2276 to avoid putting such trivia into @file{ChangeLog}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2277
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2278 @node Renaming and VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2279 @subsubsection Renaming VC Work Files and Master Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2280
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2281 @findex vc-rename-file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2282 When you rename a registered file, you must also rename its master
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2283 file correspondingly to get proper results. Use @code{vc-rename-file}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2284 to rename the source file as you specify, and rename its master file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2285 accordingly. It also updates any snapshots (@pxref{Snapshots}) that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2286 mention the file, so that they use the new name; despite this, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2287 snapshot thus modified may not completely work (@pxref{Snapshot
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2288 Caveats}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2289
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2290 You cannot use @code{vc-rename-file} on a file that is locked by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2291 someone else.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2292
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2293 @node Version Headers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2294 @subsubsection Inserting Version Control Headers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2295
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2296 Sometimes it is convenient to put version identification strings
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2297 directly into working files. Certain special strings called
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2298 @dfn{version headers} are replaced in each successive version by the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2299 number of that version.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2300
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2301 If you are using RCS, and version headers are present in your working
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2302 files, Emacs can use them to determine the current version and the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2303 locking state of the files. This is more reliable than referring to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2304 master files, which is done when there are no version headers. Note
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2305 that in a multi-branch environment, version headers are necessary to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2306 make VC behave correctly (@pxref{Multi-User Branching}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2307
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2308 Searching for version headers is controlled by the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2309 @code{vc-consult-headers}. If it is non-@code{nil}, Emacs searches for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2310 headers to determine the version number you are editing. Setting it to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2311 @code{nil} disables this feature.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2312
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2313 @kindex C-x v h
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2314 @findex vc-insert-headers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2315 You can use the @kbd{C-x v h} command (@code{vc-insert-headers}) to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2316 insert a suitable header string.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2317
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2318 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2319 @item C-x v h
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2320 Insert headers in a file for use with your version-control system.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2321 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2322
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2323 @vindex vc-header-alist
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2324 The default header string is @samp{@w{$}Id$} for RCS and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2325 @samp{@w{%}W%} for SCCS. You can specify other headers to insert by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2326 setting the variable @code{vc-header-alist}. Its value is a list of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2327 elements of the form @code{(@var{program} . @var{string})} where
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2328 @var{program} is @code{RCS} or @code{SCCS} and @var{string} is the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2329 string to use.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2330
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2331 Instead of a single string, you can specify a list of strings; then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2332 each string in the list is inserted as a separate header on a line of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2333 its own.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2334
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2335 It is often necessary to use ``superfluous'' backslashes when writing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2336 the strings that you put in this variable. This is to prevent the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2337 string in the constant from being interpreted as a header itself if the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2338 Emacs Lisp file containing it is maintained with version control.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2339
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2340 @vindex vc-comment-alist
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2341 Each header is inserted surrounded by tabs, inside comment delimiters,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2342 on a new line at point. Normally the ordinary comment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2343 start and comment end strings of the current mode are used, but for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2344 certain modes, there are special comment delimiters for this purpose;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2345 the variable @code{vc-comment-alist} specifies them. Each element of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2346 this list has the form @code{(@var{mode} @var{starter} @var{ender})}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2347
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2348 @vindex vc-static-header-alist
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2349 The variable @code{vc-static-header-alist} specifies further strings
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2350 to add based on the name of the buffer. Its value should be a list of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2351 elements of the form @code{(@var{regexp} . @var{format})}. Whenever
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2352 @var{regexp} matches the buffer name, @var{format} is inserted as part
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2353 of the header. A header line is inserted for each element that matches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2354 the buffer name, and for each string specified by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2355 @code{vc-header-alist}. The header line is made by processing the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2356 string from @code{vc-header-alist} with the format taken from the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2357 element. The default value for @code{vc-static-header-alist} is as follows:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2358
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2359 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2360 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2361 (("\\.c$" .
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2362 "\n#ifndef lint\nstatic char vcid[] = \"\%s\";\n\
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2363 #endif /* lint */\n"))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2364 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2365 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2366
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2367 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2368 It specifies insertion of text of this form:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2369
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2370 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2371 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2372
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2373 #ifndef lint
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2374 static char vcid[] = "@var{string}";
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2375 #endif /* lint */
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2376 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2377 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2378
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2379 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2380 Note that the text above starts with a blank line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2381
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2382 If you use more than one version header in a file, put them close
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2383 together in the file. The mechanism in @code{revert-buffer} that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2384 preserves markers may not handle markers positioned between two version
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2385 headers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2386
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2387 @node Customizing VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2388 @subsection Customizing VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2389
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2390 @vindex vc-handled-backends
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2391 The variable @var{vc-handled-backends} determines which version
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2392 control systems VC should handle. The default value is @code{(RCS CVS
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2393 SCCS)}, so it contains all three version systems that are currently
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2394 supported. If you want VC to ignore one or more of these systems,
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2395 exclude its name from the list.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2396
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2397 The order of systems in the list is significant: when you visit a file
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2398 is registered in more than one system (@pxref{Local Version Control}),
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2399 VC uses the system that comes first in @var{vc-handled-backends} by
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2400 default. The order is also significant when you register a file for
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2401 the first time, @pxref{Registering} for details.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2402
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2403 @menu
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2404 * General VC Options:: Options that apply to multiple back ends.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2405 * RCS and SCCS:: Options for RCS and SCCS.
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2406 * CVS Options:: Options for CVS.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2407 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2408
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2409 @node General VC Options
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2410 @subsubsection General Options
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2411
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2412 @vindex vc-make-backup-files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2413 Emacs normally does not save backup files for source files that are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2414 maintained with version control. If you want to make backup files even
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2415 for files that use version control, set the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2416 @code{vc-make-backup-files} to a non-@code{nil} value.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2417
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2418 @vindex vc-keep-workfiles
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2419 Normally the work file exists all the time, whether it is locked or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2420 not. If you set @code{vc-keep-workfiles} to @code{nil}, then checking
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2421 in a new version with @kbd{C-x C-q} deletes the work file; but any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2422 attempt to visit the file with Emacs creates it again. (With CVS, work
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2423 files are always kept.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2424
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2425 @vindex vc-follow-symlinks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2426 Editing a version-controlled file through a symbolic link can be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2427 dangerous. It bypasses the version control system---you can edit the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2428 file without locking it, and fail to check your changes in. Also,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2429 your changes might overwrite those of another user. To protect against
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2430 this, VC checks each symbolic link that you visit, to see if it points
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2431 to a file under version control.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2432
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2433 The variable @code{vc-follow-symlinks} controls what to do when a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2434 symbolic link points to a version-controlled file. If it is @code{nil},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2435 VC only displays a warning message. If it is @code{t}, VC automatically
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2436 follows the link, and visits the real file instead, telling you about
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2437 this in the echo area. If the value is @code{ask} (the default), VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2438 asks you each time whether to follow the link.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2439
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2440 @vindex vc-suppress-confirm
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2441 If @code{vc-suppress-confirm} is non-@code{nil}, then @kbd{C-x C-q}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2442 and @kbd{C-x v i} can save the current buffer without asking, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2443 @kbd{C-x v u} also operates without asking for confirmation. (This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2444 variable does not affect @kbd{C-x v c}; that operation is so drastic
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2445 that it should always ask for confirmation.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2446
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2447 @vindex vc-command-messages
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2448 VC mode does much of its work by running the shell commands for RCS,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2449 CVS and SCCS. If @code{vc-command-messages} is non-@code{nil}, VC
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2450 displays messages to indicate which shell commands it runs, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2451 additional messages when the commands finish.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2452
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2453 @vindex vc-path
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2454 You can specify additional directories to search for version control
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2455 programs by setting the variable @code{vc-path}. These directories
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2456 are searched before the usual search path. It is rarely necessary to
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2457 set this variable, because VC normally finds the proper files
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2458 automatically.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2459
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2460 @node RCS and SCCS
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2461 @subsubsection Options for RCS and SCCS
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2462
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2463 @cindex non-strict locking (RCS)
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2464 @cindex locking, non-strict (RCS)
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2465 By default, RCS uses locking to coordinate the activities of several
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2466 users, but there is a mode called @dfn{non-strict locking} in which
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2467 you can check-in changes without locking the file first. Use
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2468 @samp{rcs -U} to switch to non-strict locking for a particular file,
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2469 see the @code{rcs} manpage for details.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2470
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2471 When deducing the version control state of an RCS file, VC first
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2472 looks for an RCS version header string in the file (@pxref{Version
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2473 Headers}). If there is no header string, VC normally looks at the
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2474 file permissions of the work file; this is fast. But there might be
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2475 situations when the file permissions cannot be trusted. In this case
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2476 the master file has to be consulted, which is rather expensive. Also
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2477 the master file can only tell you @emph{if} there's any lock on the
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2478 file, but not whether your work file really contains that locked
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2479 version.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2480
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2481 @vindex vc-consult-headers
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2482 You can tell VC not to use version headers to determine the file
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2483 status by setting @code{vc-consult-headers} to @code{nil}. VC then
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2484 always uses the file permissions (if it is supposed to trust them), or
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2485 else checks the master file.
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2486
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2487 @vindex vc-mistrust-permissions
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2488 You can specify the criterion for whether to trust the file
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2489 permissions by setting the variable @code{vc-mistrust-permissions}.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2490 Its value can be @code{t} (always mistrust the file permissions and
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2491 check the master file), @code{nil} (always trust the file
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2492 permissions), or a function of one argument which makes the decision.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2493 The argument is the directory name of the @file{RCS} subdirectory. A
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2494 non-@code{nil} value from the function says to mistrust the file
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2495 permissions. If you find that the file permissions of work files are
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2496 changed erroneously, set @code{vc-mistrust-permissions} to @code{t}.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2497 Then VC always checks the master file to determine the file's status.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2498
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2499 VC determines the version control state of files under SCCS much as
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2500 with RCS. It does not consider SCCS version headers, though. Thus,
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2501 the variable @var{vc-mistrust-permissions} affects SCCS use, but
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2502 @var{vc-consult-headers} does not.
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2503
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2504 @node CVS Options
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2505 @subsubsection Options specific for CVS
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2506
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2507 @cindex locking (CVS)
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2508 By default, CVS does not use locking to coordinate the activities of
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2509 several users; anyone can change a work file at any time. However,
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2510 there are ways to restrict this, resulting in behavior that resembles
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2511 locking.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2512
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2513 @cindex CVSREAD environment variable (CVS)
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2514 For one thing, you can set the @env{CVSREAD} environment variable
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2515 (the value you use makes no difference). If this variable is defined,
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2516 CVS makes your work files read-only by default. In Emacs, you must
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2517 type @kbd{C-x C-q} to make the file writeable, so that editing works
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2518 in fact similar as if locking was used. Note however, that no actual
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2519 locking is performed, so several users can make their files writeable
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2520 at the same time. When setting @env{CVSREAD} for the first time, make
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2521 sure to check out all your modules anew, so that the file protections
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2522 are set correctly.
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2523
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2524 @cindex cvs watch feature
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2525 @cindex watching files (CVS)
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2526 Another way to achieve something similar to locking is to use the
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2527 @dfn{watch} feature of CVS. If a file is being watched, CVS makes it
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2528 read-only by default, and you must also use @kbd{C-x C-q} in Emacs to
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2529 make it writable. VC calls @code{cvs edit} to make the file writeable,
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2530 and CVS takes care to notify other developers of the fact that you
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2531 intend to change the file. See the CVS documentation for details on
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2532 using the watch feature.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2533
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2534 @vindex vc-cvs-stay-local
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2535 @cindex remote repositories (CVS)
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2536 When a file's repository is on a remote machine, VC tries to keep
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2537 network interactions to a minimum. This is controlled by the variable
36356
a10bf38295d2 (CVS Options): Mention that t is the default for vc-cvs-stay-local.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36355
diff changeset
2538 @var{vc-cvs-stay-local}. If it is @code{t} (the default), then VC uses
a10bf38295d2 (CVS Options): Mention that t is the default for vc-cvs-stay-local.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36355
diff changeset
2539 only the entry in the local CVS subdirectory to determine the file's
a10bf38295d2 (CVS Options): Mention that t is the default for vc-cvs-stay-local.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36355
diff changeset
2540 state (and possibly information returned by previous CVS commands). One
a10bf38295d2 (CVS Options): Mention that t is the default for vc-cvs-stay-local.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36355
diff changeset
2541 consequence of this is that when you have modified a file, and somebody
a10bf38295d2 (CVS Options): Mention that t is the default for vc-cvs-stay-local.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36355
diff changeset
2542 else has already checked in other changes to the file, you are not
a10bf38295d2 (CVS Options): Mention that t is the default for vc-cvs-stay-local.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36355
diff changeset
2543 notified of it until you actually try to commit. (But you can try to
a10bf38295d2 (CVS Options): Mention that t is the default for vc-cvs-stay-local.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36355
diff changeset
2544 pick up any recent changes from the repository first, using @kbd{C-x v m
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2545 @key{RET}}, @pxref{Merging}).
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2546
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2547 When @var{vc-cvs-stay-local} is @code{t}, VC also makes local
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2548 version backups, so that simple diff and revert operations are
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2549 completely local (@pxref{Version Backups}).
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2550
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2551 On the other hand, if you set @var{vc-cvs-stay-local} to @code{nil},
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2552 then VC queries the remote repository @emph{before} it decides what to
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2553 do in @code{vc-next-action} (@kbd{C-x v v}), just as it does for local
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2554 repositories. It also does not make any version backups.
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2555
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2556 You can also set @var{vc-cvs-stay-local} to a regular expression
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2557 that is matched against the repository hostname; VC then stays local
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2558 only for repositories from hosts that match the pattern.
36355
d8c0e3d0f0aa VC section updated. Added a subsection on remote repositories,
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36327
diff changeset
2559
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2560 @node Directories
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2561 @section File Directories
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2562
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2563 @cindex file directory
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2564 @cindex directory listing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2565 The file system groups files into @dfn{directories}. A @dfn{directory
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2566 listing} is a list of all the files in a directory. Emacs provides
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2567 commands to create and delete directories, and to make directory
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2568 listings in brief format (file names only) and verbose format (sizes,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2569 dates, and authors included). There is also a directory browser called
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2570 Dired; see @ref{Dired}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2571
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2572 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2573 @item C-x C-d @var{dir-or-pattern} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2574 Display a brief directory listing (@code{list-directory}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2575 @item C-u C-x C-d @var{dir-or-pattern} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2576 Display a verbose directory listing.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2577 @item M-x make-directory @key{RET} @var{dirname} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2578 Create a new directory named @var{dirname}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2579 @item M-x delete-directory @key{RET} @var{dirname} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2580 Delete the directory named @var{dirname}. It must be empty,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2581 or you get an error.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2582 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2583
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2584 @findex list-directory
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2585 @kindex C-x C-d
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2586 The command to display a directory listing is @kbd{C-x C-d}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2587 (@code{list-directory}). It reads using the minibuffer a file name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2588 which is either a directory to be listed or a wildcard-containing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2589 pattern for the files to be listed. For example,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2590
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2591 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2592 C-x C-d /u2/emacs/etc @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2593 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2594
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2595 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2596 lists all the files in directory @file{/u2/emacs/etc}. Here is an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2597 example of specifying a file name pattern:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2598
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2599 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2600 C-x C-d /u2/emacs/src/*.c @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2601 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2602
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2603 Normally, @kbd{C-x C-d} prints a brief directory listing containing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2604 just file names. A numeric argument (regardless of value) tells it to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2605 make a verbose listing including sizes, dates, and authors (like
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2606 @samp{ls -l}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2607
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2608 @vindex list-directory-brief-switches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2609 @vindex list-directory-verbose-switches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2610 The text of a directory listing is obtained by running @code{ls} in an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2611 inferior process. Two Emacs variables control the switches passed to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2612 @code{ls}: @code{list-directory-brief-switches} is a string giving the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2613 switches to use in brief listings (@code{"-CF"} by default), and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2614 @code{list-directory-verbose-switches} is a string giving the switches to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2615 use in a verbose listing (@code{"-l"} by default).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2616
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2617 @node Comparing Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2618 @section Comparing Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2619 @cindex comparing files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2620
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2621 @findex diff
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2622 @vindex diff-switches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2623 The command @kbd{M-x diff} compares two files, displaying the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2624 differences in an Emacs buffer named @samp{*Diff*}. It works by running
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2625 the @code{diff} program, using options taken from the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2626 @code{diff-switches}, whose value should be a string.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2627
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2628 The buffer @samp{*Diff*} has Compilation mode as its major mode, so
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2629 you can use @kbd{C-x `} to visit successive changed locations in the two
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2630 source files. You can also move to a particular hunk of changes and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2631 type @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c}, or click @kbd{Mouse-2} on it, to move
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2632 to the corresponding source location. You can also use the other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2633 special commands of Compilation mode: @key{SPC} and @key{DEL} for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2634 scrolling, and @kbd{M-p} and @kbd{M-n} for cursor motion.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2635 @xref{Compilation}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2636
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2637 @findex diff-backup
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2638 The command @kbd{M-x diff-backup} compares a specified file with its most
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2639 recent backup. If you specify the name of a backup file,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2640 @code{diff-backup} compares it with the source file that it is a backup
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2641 of.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2642
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2643 @findex compare-windows
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2644 The command @kbd{M-x compare-windows} compares the text in the current
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2645 window with that in the next window. Comparison starts at point in each
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2646 window, and each starting position is pushed on the mark ring in its
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2647 respective buffer. Then point moves forward in each window, a character
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2648 at a time, until a mismatch between the two windows is reached. Then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2649 the command is finished. For more information about windows in Emacs,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2650 @ref{Windows}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2651
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2652 @vindex compare-ignore-case
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2653 With a numeric argument, @code{compare-windows} ignores changes in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2654 whitespace. If the variable @code{compare-ignore-case} is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2655 non-@code{nil}, it ignores differences in case as well.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2656
31076
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
2657 @findex diff-mode
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
2658 @cindex diffs
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
2659 @cindex patches
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
2660 @cindex Diff mode
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2661 Differences between versions of files are often distributed as
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2662 @dfn{patches}, which are the output from @command{diff} or a version
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2663 control system that uses @command{diff}. @kbd{M-x diff-mode} turns on
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2664 Diff mode, a major mode for viewing and editing patches, either as
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2665 ``unified diffs'' or ``context diffs.''
31076
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
2666
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
2667 @cindex Smerge mode
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
2668 @findex smerge-mode
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
2669 @cindex failed merges
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
2670 @cindex merges, failed
36274
91f2160d4468 Remove two more redundant index entries.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
2671 @cindex comparing 3 files (@code{diff3})
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2672 You can use @kbd{M-x smerge-mode} to turn on Smerge mode, a minor
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2673 mode for editing output from the @command{diff3} program. This is
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2674 typically the result of a failed merge from a version control system
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2675 ``update'' outside VC, due to conflicting changes to a file. Smerge
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2676 mode provides commands to resolve conflicts by selecting specific
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2677 changes.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2678
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2679 See also @ref{Emerge}, and @ref{Top,,, ediff, The Ediff Manual}, for
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2680 convenient facilities for merging two similar files.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2681
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2682 @node Misc File Ops
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2683 @section Miscellaneous File Operations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2684
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2685 Emacs has commands for performing many other operations on files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2686 All operate on one file; they do not accept wildcard file names.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2687
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2688 @findex view-file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2689 @cindex viewing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2690 @cindex View mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2691 @cindex mode, View
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2692 @kbd{M-x view-file} allows you to scan or read a file by sequential
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2693 screenfuls. It reads a file name argument using the minibuffer. After
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2694 reading the file into an Emacs buffer, @code{view-file} displays the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2695 beginning. You can then type @key{SPC} to scroll forward one windowful,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2696 or @key{DEL} to scroll backward. Various other commands are provided
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2697 for moving around in the file, but none for changing it; type @kbd{?}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2698 while viewing for a list of them. They are mostly the same as normal
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2699 Emacs cursor motion commands. To exit from viewing, type @kbd{q}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2700 The commands for viewing are defined by a special major mode called View
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2701 mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2702
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2703 A related command, @kbd{M-x view-buffer}, views a buffer already present
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2704 in Emacs. @xref{Misc Buffer}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2705
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2706 @findex insert-file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2707 @kbd{M-x insert-file} inserts a copy of the contents of the specified
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2708 file into the current buffer at point, leaving point unchanged before the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2709 contents and the mark after them.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2710
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2711 @findex write-region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2712 @kbd{M-x write-region} is the inverse of @kbd{M-x insert-file}; it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2713 copies the contents of the region into the specified file. @kbd{M-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2714 append-to-file} adds the text of the region to the end of the specified
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2715 file. @xref{Accumulating Text}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2716
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2717 @findex delete-file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2718 @cindex deletion (of files)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2719 @kbd{M-x delete-file} deletes the specified file, like the @code{rm}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2720 command in the shell. If you are deleting many files in one directory, it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2721 may be more convenient to use Dired (@pxref{Dired}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2722
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2723 @findex rename-file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2724 @kbd{M-x rename-file} reads two file names @var{old} and @var{new} using
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2725 the minibuffer, then renames file @var{old} as @var{new}. If a file named
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2726 @var{new} already exists, you must confirm with @kbd{yes} or renaming is not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2727 done; this is because renaming causes the old meaning of the name @var{new}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2728 to be lost. If @var{old} and @var{new} are on different file systems, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2729 file @var{old} is copied and deleted.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2730
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2731 @findex add-name-to-file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2732 The similar command @kbd{M-x add-name-to-file} is used to add an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2733 additional name to an existing file without removing its old name.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2734 The new name must belong on the same file system that the file is on.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2735
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2736 @findex copy-file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2737 @cindex copying files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2738 @kbd{M-x copy-file} reads the file @var{old} and writes a new file named
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2739 @var{new} with the same contents. Confirmation is required if a file named
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2740 @var{new} already exists, because copying has the consequence of overwriting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2741 the old contents of the file @var{new}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2742
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2743 @findex make-symbolic-link
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2744 @kbd{M-x make-symbolic-link} reads two file names @var{target} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2745 @var{linkname}, then creates a symbolic link named @var{linkname} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2746 pointing at @var{target}. The effect is that future attempts to open file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2747 @var{linkname} will refer to whatever file is named @var{target} at the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2748 time the opening is done, or will get an error if the name @var{target} is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2749 not in use at that time. This command does not expand the argument
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2750 @var{target}, so that it allows you to specify a relative name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2751 as the target of the link.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2752
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2753 Confirmation is required when creating the link if @var{linkname} is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2754 in use. Note that not all systems support symbolic links.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2755
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2756 @node Compressed Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2757 @section Accessing Compressed Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2758 @cindex compression
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2759 @cindex uncompression
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2760 @cindex Auto Compression mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2761 @cindex mode, Auto Compression
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2762 @pindex gzip
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2763
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2764 @findex auto-compression-mode
28123
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2765 @vindex auto-compression-mode
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2766 Emacs comes with a library that can automatically uncompress
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2767 compressed files when you visit them, and automatically recompress them
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2768 if you alter them and save them. To enable this feature, type the
28123
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2769 command @kbd{M-x auto-compression-mode}. You can enable it permanently
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2770 by customizing the option @var{auto-compression-mode}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2771
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2772 When automatic compression (which implies automatic uncompression as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2773 well) is enabled, Emacs recognizes compressed files by their file names.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2774 File names ending in @samp{.gz} indicate a file compressed with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2775 @code{gzip}. Other endings indicate other compression programs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2776
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2777 Automatic uncompression and compression apply to all the operations in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2778 which Emacs uses the contents of a file. This includes visiting it,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2779 saving it, inserting its contents into a buffer, loading it, and byte
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2780 compiling it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2781
28123
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2782 @node File Archives
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2783 @section File Archives
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2784 @cindex mode, tar
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2785 @cindex Tar mode
36274
91f2160d4468 Remove two more redundant index entries.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
2786 @cindex file archives
29683
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2787
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2788 A file whose name ends in @samp{.tar} is normally an @dfn{archive}
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2789 made by the @code{tar} program. Emacs views these files in a special
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2790 mode called Tar mode which provides a Dired-like list of the contents
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2791 (@pxref{Dired}). You can move around through the list just as you
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2792 would in Dired, and visit the subfiles contained in the archive.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2793 However, not all Dired commands are available in Tar mode.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2794
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2795 If you enable Auto Compression mode (@pxref{Compressed Files}), then
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2796 Tar mode is used also for compressed archives---files with extensions
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2797 @samp{.tgz}, @code{.tar.Z} and @code{.tar.gz}.
29683
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2798
36385
d7ca85bd6906 Clean up recent VC updates.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36360
diff changeset
2799 The keys @kbd{e}, @kbd{f} and @key{RET} all extract a component file
29683
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2800 into its own buffer. You can edit it there and when you save the buffer
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2801 the edited version will replace the version in the Tar buffer. @kbd{v}
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2802 extracts a file into a buffer in View mode. @kbd{o} extracts the file
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2803 and displays it in another window, so you could edit the file and
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2804 operate on the archive simultaneously. @kbd{d} marks a file for
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2805 deletion when you later use @kbd{x}, and @kbd{u} unmarks a file, as in
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2806 Dired. @kbd{C} copies a file from the archive to disk and @kbd{R}
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2807 renames a file. @kbd{g} reverts the buffer from the archive on disk.
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2808
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2809 The keys @kbd{M}, @kbd{G}, and @kbd{O} change the file's permission
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2810 bits, group, and owner, respectively.
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2811
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2812 If your display supports colors and the mouse, moving the mouse
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2813 pointer across a file name highlights that file name, indicating that
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2814 you can click on it. Clicking @kbd{Mouse-2} on the highlighted file
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2815 name extracts the file into a buffer and displays that buffer.
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2816
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2817 Saving the Tar buffer writes a new version of the archive to disk with
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2818 the changes you made to the components.
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2819
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2820 You don't need the @code{tar} program to use Tar mode---Emacs reads
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2821 the archives directly. However, accessing compressed archives
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2822 requires the appropriate uncompression program.
31076
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
2823
28123
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2824 @cindex Archive mode
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2825 @cindex mode, archive
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2826 @cindex @code{arc}
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2827 @cindex @code{jar}
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2828 @cindex @code{zip}
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2829 @cindex @code{lzh}
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2830 @cindex @code{zoo}
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2831 @pindex arc
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2832 @pindex jar
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2833 @pindex zip
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2834 @pindex lzh
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2835 @pindex zoo
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2836 @cindex Java class archives
29683
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2837 @cindex unzip archives
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2838 A separate but similar Archive mode is used for archives produced by
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2839 the programs @code{arc}, @code{jar}, @code{lzh}, @code{zip}, and
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2840 @code{zoo}, which have extensions corresponding to the program names.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2841
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2842 The keybindings of Archive mode are similar to those in Tar mode,
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2843 with the addition of the @kbd{m} key which marks a file for subsequent
29683
324386e590b7 (File Archives): Remove redundant index entries. Add some more Tar
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 29556
diff changeset
2844 operations, and @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} which unmarks all the marked files.
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2845 Also, the @kbd{a} key toggles the display of detailed file
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2846 information, for those archive types where it won't fit in a single
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2847 line. Operations such as renaming a subfile, or changing its mode or
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2848 owner, are supported only for some of the archive formats.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2849
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2850 Unlike Tar mode, Archive mode runs the archiving program to unpack
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2851 and repack archives. Details of the program names and their options
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2852 can be set in the @samp{Archive} Customize group. However, you don't
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2853 need these programs to the archive table of contents, only to extract
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2854 or manipulate the subfiles in the archive.
28123
6e2e72ee55a6 (Compressed Files): Note custom option.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26105
diff changeset
2855
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2856 @node Remote Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2857 @section Remote Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2858
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2859 @cindex FTP
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2860 @cindex remote file access
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2861 You can refer to files on other machines using a special file name syntax:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2862
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2863 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2864 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2865 /@var{host}:@var{filename}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2866 /@var{user}@@@var{host}:@var{filename}
26105
c881de80a22b Mention vc-ignore-vc-files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2867 /@var{user}@@@var{host}#@var{port}:@var{filename}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2868 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2869 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2870
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2871 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2872 When you do this, Emacs uses the FTP program to read and write files on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2873 the specified host. It logs in through FTP using your user name or the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2874 name @var{user}. It may ask you for a password from time to time; this
26105
c881de80a22b Mention vc-ignore-vc-files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2875 is used for logging in on @var{host}. The form using @var{port} allows
c881de80a22b Mention vc-ignore-vc-files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2876 you to access servers running on a non-default TCP port.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2877
35908
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2878 @cindex backups for remote files
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2879 @vindex ange-ftp-make-backup-files
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2880 If you want to disable backups for remote files, set the variable
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2881 @code{ange-ftp-make-backup-files} to @code{nil}.
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2882
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2883 @cindex ange-ftp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2884 @vindex ange-ftp-default-user
35908
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2885 @cindex user name for remote file access
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2886 Normally, if you do not specify a user name in a remote file name,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2887 that means to use your own user name. But if you set the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2888 @code{ange-ftp-default-user} to a string, that string is used instead.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2889 (The Emacs package that implements FTP file access is called
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2890 @code{ange-ftp}.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2891
35908
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2892 @cindex anonymous FTP
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2893 @vindex ange-ftp-generate-anonymous-password
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2894 To visit files accessible by anonymous FTP, you use special user
36155
3594ca3f5f64 Fix some Texinfo usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36136
diff changeset
2895 names @samp{anonymous} or @samp{ftp}. Passwords for these user names
3594ca3f5f64 Fix some Texinfo usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36136
diff changeset
2896 are handled specially. The variable
35908
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2897 @code{ange-ftp-generate-anonymous-password} controls what happens: if
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2898 the value of this variable is a string, then that string is used as
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2899 the password; if non-@code{nil} (the default), then the value of
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2900 @code{user-mail-address} is used; if @code{nil}, the user is prompted
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2901 for a password as normal.
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2902
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2903 @cindex firewall, and accessing remote files
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2904 @cindex gateway, and remote file access with @code{ange-ftp}
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2905 @vindex ange-ftp-smart-gateway
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2906 @vindex ange-ftp-gateway-host
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2907 Sometimes you may be unable to access files on a remote machine
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2908 because a @dfn{firewall} in between blocks the connection for security
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2909 reasons. If you can log in on a @dfn{gateway} machine from which the
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2910 target files @emph{are} accessible, and whose FTP server supports
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2911 gatewaying features, you can still use remote file names; all you have
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2912 to do is specify the name of the gateway machine by setting the
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2913 variable @code{ange-ftp-gateway-host}, and set
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2914 @code{ange-ftp-smart-gateway} to @code{t}. Otherwise you may be able
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2915 to make remote file names work, but the procedure is complex. You can
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2916 read the instructions by typing @kbd{M-x finder-commentary @key{RET}
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2917 ange-ftp @key{RET}}.
35908
4ba2a6029c03 (Remote Files): Explain how to use ange-ftp behind firewalls. Add a
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35731
diff changeset
2918
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2919 @vindex file-name-handler-alist
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2920 @cindex disabling remote files
26105
c881de80a22b Mention vc-ignore-vc-files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2921 You can entirely turn off the FTP file name feature by removing the
c881de80a22b Mention vc-ignore-vc-files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2922 entries @var{ange-ftp-completion-hook-function} and
c881de80a22b Mention vc-ignore-vc-files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2923 @var{ange-ftp-hook-function} from the variable
28327
f7b17a6af3db (Visiting): List wildcard chars. Mention find-file-wildcards.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28123
diff changeset
2924 @code{file-name-handler-alist}. You can turn off the feature in
f7b17a6af3db (Visiting): List wildcard chars. Mention find-file-wildcards.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28123
diff changeset
2925 individual cases by quoting the file name with @samp{/:} (@pxref{Quoted
f7b17a6af3db (Visiting): List wildcard chars. Mention find-file-wildcards.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28123
diff changeset
2926 File Names}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2927
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2928 @node Quoted File Names
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2929 @section Quoted File Names
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2930
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2931 @cindex quoting file names
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2932 You can @dfn{quote} an absolute file name to prevent special
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2933 characters and syntax in it from having their special effects.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2934 The way to do this is to add @samp{/:} at the beginning.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2935
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2936 For example, you can quote a local file name which appears remote, to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2937 prevent it from being treated as a remote file name. Thus, if you have
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2938 a directory named @file{/foo:} and a file named @file{bar} in it, you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2939 can refer to that file in Emacs as @samp{/:/foo:/bar}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2940
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2941 @samp{/:} can also prevent @samp{~} from being treated as a special
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2942 character for a user's home directory. For example, @file{/:/tmp/~hack}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2943 refers to a file whose name is @file{~hack} in directory @file{/tmp}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2944
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2945 Likewise, quoting with @samp{/:} is one way to enter in the minibuffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2946 a file name that contains @samp{$}. However, the @samp{/:} must be at
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2947 the beginning of the buffer in order to quote @samp{$}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2948
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2949 You can also quote wildcard characters with @samp{/:}, for visiting.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2950 For example, @file{/:/tmp/foo*bar} visits the file @file{/tmp/foo*bar}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2951 However, in most cases you can simply type the wildcard characters for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2952 themselves. For example, if the only file name in @file{/tmp} that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2953 starts with @samp{foo} and ends with @samp{bar} is @file{foo*bar}, then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2954 specifying @file{/tmp/foo*bar} will visit just @file{/tmp/foo*bar}.
28327
f7b17a6af3db (Visiting): List wildcard chars. Mention find-file-wildcards.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28123
diff changeset
2955 Another way is to specify @file{/tmp/foo[*]bar}.
28526
297e03ccd7e6 (Backup): backup-enable-predicate.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28327
diff changeset
2956
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2957 @node File Name Cache
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2958 @section File Name Cache
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2959
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2960 @cindex file name caching
28671
678e1643ac82 ffap, filecache, locate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28526
diff changeset
2961 @cindex cache of file names
678e1643ac82 ffap, filecache, locate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28526
diff changeset
2962 @pindex find
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2963 @kindex C-@key{TAB}
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2964 @findex file-cache-minibuffer-complete
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2965 You can use the @dfn{file name cache} to make it easy to locate a
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2966 file by name, without having to remember exactly where it is located.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2967 When typing a file name in the minibuffer, @kbd{C-@key{tab}}
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2968 (@code{file-cache-minibuffer-complete}) completes it using the file
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2969 name cache. If you repeat @kbd{C-@key{tab}}, that cycles through the
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2970 possible completions of what you had originally typed. Note that the
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2971 @kbd{C-@key{tab}} character cannot be typed on most text-only
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2972 terminals.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2973
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2974 The file name cache does not fill up automatically. Instead, you
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2975 load file names into the cache using these commands:
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2976
31076
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
2977 @findex file-cache-add-directory
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2978 @table @kbd
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2979 @item M-x file-cache-add-directory @key{RET} @var{directory} @key{RET}
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2980 Add each file name in @var{directory} to the file name cache.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2981 @item M-x file-cache-add-directory-using-find @key{RET} @var{directory} @key{RET}
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2982 Add each file name in @var{directory} and all of its nested
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2983 subdirectories to the file name cache.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2984 @item M-x file-cache-add-directory-using-locate @key{RET} @var{directory} @key{RET}
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2985 Add each file name in @var{directory} and all of its nested
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2986 subdirectories to the file name cache, using @command{locate} to find
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2987 them all.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2988 @item M-x file-cache-add-directory-list @key{RET} @var{variable} @key{RET}
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2989 Add each file name in each directory listed in @var{variable}
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2990 to the file name cache. @var{variable} should be a Lisp variable
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2991 such as @code{load-path} or @code{exec-path}, whose value is a list
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2992 of directory names.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2993 @item M-x file-cache-clear-cache @key{RET}
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2994 Clear the cache; that is, remove all file names from it.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2995 @end table
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2996
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2997 @node File Conveniences
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
2998 @section Convenience Features for Finding Files
31076
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
2999
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
3000 @findex recentf-mode
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
3001 @vindex recentf-mode
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
3002 @findex recentf-save-list
9c00fd66ec24 (File Shadowing): New.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31043
diff changeset
3003 @findex recentf-edit-list
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3004 If you enable Recentf mode, with @kbd{M-x recentf-mode}, the
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3005 @samp{Files} menu includes a submenu containing a list of recently
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3006 opened files. @kbd{M-x recentf-save-list} saves the current
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3007 recent-file-list to a file, and @kbd{M-x recentf-edit-list} edits it.
32221
43d80d6d2a8b auto-image-file-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31076
diff changeset
3008
43d80d6d2a8b auto-image-file-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31076
diff changeset
3009 @findex auto-image-file-mode
43d80d6d2a8b auto-image-file-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31076
diff changeset
3010 @findex mode, auto-image-file
43d80d6d2a8b auto-image-file-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31076
diff changeset
3011 @cindex images, visiting
43d80d6d2a8b auto-image-file-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31076
diff changeset
3012 @cindex visiting image files
43d80d6d2a8b auto-image-file-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31076
diff changeset
3013 @vindex image-file-name-regexps
43d80d6d2a8b auto-image-file-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31076
diff changeset
3014 @vindex image-file-name-extensions
36136
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3015 When Auto-image-file minor mode is enabled, visiting an image file
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3016 displays it as an image, not as text. Likewise, inserting an image
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3017 file into a buffer inserts it as an image. This works only when Emacs
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3018 can display the relevant image type. The variables
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3019 @code{image-file-name-extensions} or @code{image-file-name-regexps}
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3020 control which file names are recognized as containing images.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3021
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3022 The @kbd{M-x ffap} command generalizes @code{find-file} with more
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3023 powerful heuristic defaults (@pxref{FFAP}), often based on the text at
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3024 point. Partial Completion mode offers other features extending
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3025 @code{find-file}, which can be used with @code{ffap}.
a5ae50ec6fe7 Many small clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35919
diff changeset
3026 @xref{Completion Options}.